573878
2
Zoom out
Zoom in
Previous page
1/126
Next page
Operating Instructions
HTZ585DVD-AP
DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD
ġ
௦ԞᏣ
XV-DV585AP
Speaker System |ġ
ඵᖑᏣقಜ
S-DV585
HTZ787DVD
DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD
ġ
௦ԞᏣ
XV-DV787
Speaker System |ġ
ඵᖑᏣقಜ
S-DV787T
S-DV5SW
HTZ787DVD-AP
DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD
ġ
௦ԞᏣ
XV-DV787AP
Speaker System |ġ
ඵᖑᏣقಜ
S-DV787T
S-DV5SW
HTZ-FS30DVD
DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD
ġ
௦ԞᏣ
XV-DV30FS
Speaker System |ġ
ඵᖑᏣقಜ
S-DV30FS
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD
ġ
௦ԞᏣ
XV-DV30FSAP
Speaker System |ġ
ඵᖑᏣقಜ
S-DV30FS
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 1 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert the user to the
presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the appliance.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol,
within an equilateral triangle, is intended to
alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
“dangerous voltage” within the product’s
enclosure that may be of sufficient
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric
shock to persons.
CAUTION:
TO PREVENT THE RISK OF ELECTRIC
SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR
BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS
INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED
SERVICE PERSONNEL.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
IMPORTANT
D3-4-2-1-1_A1_En

&$(# !'&!"'*'%#%"""#%)!'%
"%&"-%"!"'#!,"!'!%
*'$(!%'&$(# !'&(&)&"%
"*%#"'"%+#"&''"%##!&#&!%!
"% "&'(%
!

+$!)$)+ !!%$,'(*%%!- '(
$' #)$$*#)'-$'' $#(*')))
%$,'(*%%!-+$!)$)',') (*# )
, !!*(")()'&* '+$!)
$',' ))#$#)''%#!
#


VENTILATION CAUTION
When installing this unit, make sure to leave space
around the unit for ventilation to improve heat
radiation (at least 10 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and
10 cm at each side).
WARNING
Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for
ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the
product, and to protect it from overheating. To
prevent fire hazard, the openings should never be
blocked or covered with items (such as newspapers,
table-cloths, curtains) or by operating the
equipment on thick carpet or a bed.
D3-4-2-1-7b_A_En
WARNING
To prevent a fire hazard, do not place any naked
flame sources (such as a lighted candle) on the
equipment.
D3-4-2-1-7a_A_En
CAUTION
The STANDBY/ON switch on this unit will not
completely shut off all power from the AC outlet.
Since the power cord serves as the main disconnect
device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from
the AC outlet to shut down all power. Therefore,
make sure the unit has been installed so that the
power cord can be easily unplugged from the AC
outlet in case of an accident. To avoid fire hazard,
the power cord should also be unplugged from the
AC outlet when left
unused for a long period of time
(for example, when on vacation).
D3-4-2-2-2a_A_En
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 2 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
POWER-CORD CAUTION
Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not pull out the
plug by tugging the cord and never touch the power
cord when your hands are wet as this could cause a
short circuit or electric shock. Do not place the unit, a
piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or pinch the
cord. Never make a knot in the cord or tie it with other
cords. The power cords should be routed such that they
are not likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord
can cause a fire or give you an electrical shock. Check
the power cord once in a while. When you find it
damaged, ask your nearest PIONEER authorized
service center or your dealer for a replacement.
S002*_En
CAUTION
This product is a class 1 laser product, but this
product contains a laser diode higher than Class 1.
To ensure continued safety, do not remove any covers
or attempt to gain access to the inside of the product.
Refer all servicing to qualified personnel.
The following caution label appears on your unit.
Location: top of the unit
CLASS 1
LASER PRODUCT
D3-4-2-1-8*_C_En
Operating Environment
Operating environment temperature and humidity:
+5 °C to +35 °C (+41 °F to +95 °F); less than 85 %RH
(cooling vents not blocked)
Do not install this unit in a poorly ventilated area, or in
locations exposed to high humidity or direct sunlight (or
strong artificial light)
D3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_En
If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC
outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed
and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and
mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of
this unit should be performed only by qualified
service personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the
cut-off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make
sure it is properly disposed of after
removal.
The equipment should be disconnected by removing
the mains plug from the wall socket when left unused
for a long period of time (for example, when on
vacation).
D3-4-2-2-1a_A1_En







HTZ585DVD_EN.book 3 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
4
En
Thank you for buying this Pioneer product.
Please read through these operating instructions so that you will know how to operate your model
properly. After you have finished reading the instructions,
put them in a safe place for future referenc
e.
Contents
01 Speaker Setup Guide
Home theater sound setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
5 spot/4 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . .6
3 spot/2 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Preparing the speakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Preparation common to all models. . . . . . .6
Preparation only for the HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6
Preparation only for the
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP . . . . . . . .7
Preparation only for the
HTZ585DVD-AP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Wall mounting the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Before mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Attaching the brackets only for the
HTZ-585DVD-AP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10
Attaching the speakers only for the
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP . . . . . . .10
Additional notes on speaker placement . . .10
02 Connecting up
Basic connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
03 Controls and displays
Front panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Putting the batteries in the remote
control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Using the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
04 Getting started
Setting Speaker Layout. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Using the Auto MCACC setup for optimal
surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Using the on-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . .18
Playing discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Basic playback controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
Resume and Last Memory . . . . . . . . . . . .19
DVD-Video disc menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus . . . . . .20
Listening to the radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
Improving poor FM reception . . . . . . . . . .20
Reducing AM reception noise . . . . . . . . .21
Memorizing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . .21
Audio input settings from the TVs
(TV Input) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Listening to other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
05 Listening to your system
Selecting Listening mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Auto listening mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Listening in surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings. . . . . . . 23
Using Front Stage Surround Advance . . . . 23
Listening in stereo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Listening with headphones . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Listening with Acoustic Calibration EQ. . . . 24
Using the Sound Retriever . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Enhancing dialogue. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Using the Tone controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Adjusting the bass and treble . . . . . . . . . 24
Quiet and Midnight modes . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Boosting the bass level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
06 Disc playback features
Scanning discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Playing in slow motion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . . . 26
Playing a JPEG slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Browsing DVD or Video CD/Super VCD
discs with the Disc Navigator. . . . . . . . . . . 27
Browsing Windows Media
TM
Audio (WMA),
MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and
JPEG files with the Disc Navigator . . . . . . . 28
Using Playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Programming playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Listening to playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Clearing files from a playlist. . . . . . . . . . . 29
Looping a section of a disc. . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Using repeat play. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Using random play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Creating a program list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Other functions available from the
program menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Searching a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Switching subtitles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Switching language/audio channels . . . . . 31
Zooming the screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Switching camera angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Displaying disc information . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 4 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
5
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
07 USB playback and Recording
Using the USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Recording the tracks of a music CD on
a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Recording all the tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Recording specific tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
08 Singing karaoke
Singing karaoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Changing the vocal mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Changing the backing track . . . . . . . . . . 34
09 Surround sound settings
Using the Sound Setup menu . . . . . . . . . . 35
10 Video Adjust menu
Video Adjust menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
11 Initial Settings menu
Using the Initial Settings menu . . . . . . . . . 38
Digital Audio Out settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Video Output settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Language settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Display settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Options settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Parental Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
About DivX
®
VOD content . . . . . . . . . . . 41
12 Other connections
Connecting using the component video
output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
About progressive scan video . . . . . . . . . 43
Connecting for digital audio . . . . . . . . . . 43
Connecting an analog audio
component. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Connecting using HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Switching the HDMI audio setting . . . . . 44
Resetting the HDMI connection . . . . . . . 44
About HDMI. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Connecting external antennas . . . . . . . . . 45
Bluetooth
®
ADAPTER for Wireless
Enjoyment of Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Wireless music play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Remote control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Connecting Optional Bluetooth
ADAPTER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth
wireless technology device . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Listening to Music Contents of Bluetooth
wireless technology device with
Your System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Clearing Pairing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
13 KURO LINK
Making the KURO LINK connections . . . . 48
KURO LINK Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Setting the KURO LINK mode. . . . . . . . . 49
Before using synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Synchronized amp mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Synchronized amp mode operations . . . .49
Canceling synchronized amp mode . . . . .49
14 Additional information
Optional system settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Setting the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Disc/content format playback
compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Disc compatibility table . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
About DVD+R/DVD+RW
compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
About DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
About WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
About MPEG-4 AAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
About WMA. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Using and taking care of discs . . . . . . . . . .54
DVD Video regions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Installation and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Hints on installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Cleaning the pickup lens . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Problems with condensation . . . . . . . . . . 55
Moving the system unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . . . .55
Widescreen TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Standard TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
DVD/CD/Video CD player . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Tuner. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
USB connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Bluetooth connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Using the language code list . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Country/Area code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
This product incorporates copyright
protection technology that is protected
by method claims of certain U.S. patents
and other intellectual property rights
owned by Macrovision Corporation and
other rights owners. Use of this copyright
protection technology must be authorized
by Macrovision Corporation, and is intended
for home and other limited viewing uses
only unless otherwise authorized by
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse
engineering or disassembly is prohibited.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 5 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Speaker Setup Guide01
6
En
Chapter 1
Speaker Setup Guide
Home theater sound setup
Not applicable to the HTZ-FS30DVD model
Depending on the size and characteristics of
your room, you can place your speakers in one
of two ways using this system. For the speaker
configuration, see the Setup Guide.
5 spot/4 spot speaker layout
This is a standard multichannel surround sound
speaker setup for optimal 5.1 channel home
theater sound.
1
3 spot/2 spot speaker layout
This setup is ideal when rear surround speaker
placement isn’t possible or you want to avoid
running long speaker cables in your listening
area.
2
Preparing the speakers
Preparation common to all models
Attaching non-skid pads
Attach the smaller non-skid pads to the
base of each of speakers. The four large non-
skid pads are for the subwoofer.
Use the supplied adhesive to attach 3 or 4 pads to
the base (flat surface) of each speaker.
Preparation only for the HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
The layouts of the 5/4 spot speaker and 3/2 spot
speaker are the same:
Assembling the speaker stands
Attach the speaker stand bases to the
stems using the screws provided.
Once you have aligned the stem and base,
secure with the small screws at the points see
the Setup Guide. Note that the speaker should
face in the direction of the base of the isosceles
triangle.
CAUTION
Be careful not to tighten screws
excessively.
If excessive force is used to tighten screws,
the threads of screw and/or nut may be
damaged. Use a middle-sized manual
screwdriver during assembly.
Do not use power screwdrivers or oversized
screwdrivers that may exert excessive force
on the screws and nuts.
Confirm that no foreign matter is stuck to
the stand base or the tall speaker during
assembly.
If the unit is assembled with foreign matter
stuck between the stand base and the tall
speaker the unit may not be assembled
securely, resulting in tipping or falling.
Note
1 The front left and right speaker should be about 1.8 m to 2.7 m apart.
2 The surround left and right speakers should be about 1.5 m apart.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 6 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Speaker Setup Guide 01
7
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Do not stand on the speaker stand base of
the tall speaker to push or swing the
speaker. The speaker may fall and break, or
someone may be injured. Pay special
attention to children.
Securing your front and surround
speakers
Secure each of the front and surround
speakers using the plastic catch provided.
Screw two supporting hooks into the wall
behind the speaker. Pass a thick cord around
the hooks and through the plastic catch so that
the speaker is stabilized (make sure to test that
it supports the weight of the speaker). After
installing, make sure the speaker is securely
fixed.
CAUTION
The plastic catch is not a mounting fixture,
and the speaker should not be hung
directly from the wall using this catch.
Always use a cord when stabilizing the
speaker.
Pioneer disclaims all responsibility for any
losses or damage resulting from improper
assembly, installation, insufficient
strength of the installation materials,
misuse, or natural disasters.
When placing this unit, ensure that it is
firmly secured and avoid areas where it
may be likely to fall and cause injury in the
event of a natural disaster (such as an
earthquake).
Preparation only for the
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
Assembling the speaker stands and
securing your front speakers
1 Install the pole with a circular nut
attached onto the speaker stand base, using
the hexagon nuts and washers provided.
Use the spanner provided for installation.
CAUTION
Be careful that the stand does not fall over
when installing the pole.
Plastic catch
Sufficiently thick
cord
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 7 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Speaker Setup Guide01
8
En
2 Lay the speaker stand on its side, and pass
the speaker cables into the hole in the
speaker stand base and through the pole.
3 Fit the provided cap into the top of the
pole.
Pass the speaker cables through the middle of
the cap as shown in the illustration and fit the
cap.
4 Attach the provided metal catches to the
pole.
Attach the metal catches so that they
sandwich the pole and then insert the
screw into the screw hole.
Use caution so that the metal catches do
not slip or come off until the speaker is
installed.
5 Install the speaker.
Connect the speaker cables to the
connectors of the speaker.
Fit the screws (M5 x 12 mm) through the
metal catches that were attached in step 4
and into the screw holes in the speaker,
and temporarily tighten the screws.
Referring to the scale on the rear side of
the speaker, adjust the positions of the
right and left speaker stands to the same
height according to your preference, and
tighten the screws.
6 Finely adjust the positions of the two
poles.
Adjust the poles so that they are straight and
level when viewed directly from the side or
above.
CAUTION
The shape of the front-side metal catch is
dierent from that of the rear-side one.
Pay attention to the installation direction
of the metal catches.
Front side
Rear side
Screws
OK NG
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 8 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Speaker Setup Guide 01
9
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Preparation only for the HTZ585DVD-AP
Stack the speakers and fix the brackets
Each speaker is provided with a color-coded
indicator on the model label on the rear side to
assist identification. Refer to the color
indicators and install the speakers correctly.
As shown in the illustration, stack the
speakers. Align the bracket with the respective
upper and lower screw holes as shown in each
figure below and fasten the screws securely.
4 spot/3 spot speaker layout:
2 spot speaker layout:
CAUTION
Do not attempt to carry the speakers when
they are connected with the bracket. Doing
so may cause damage to the bracket or
worsen damage to the bracket and
speakers in the event they are dropped.
Wall mounting the speakers
For the HTZ585DVD-AP, attached mounting
brackets for the front, center and surround
speakers. For the HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-
AP, only the center speaker has a mounting
hole. For the HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP,
the front speaker have mounting holes.
Before mounting
Remember that the speaker system is
heavy and that its weight could cause the
screws to work loose, or the wall material to
fail to support it, resulting in the speaker
falling. Make sure that the wall you intend
to mount the speakers on is strong enough
to support them. Do not mount on plywood
or soft surface walls.
Mounting screws are not supplied. Use
screws suitable for the wall material and
support the weight of the speaker.
CAUTION
If you are unsure of the qualities and
strength of the wall, consult a professional
for advice.
Pioneer is not responsible for any
accidents or damage that result from
improper installation.
Screw
Front
speaker
Bracket
Front speaker
Center speaker
Left
Green
White
Green
Red
Right
4 spot:
Front speaker
Surround
speaker
Left
Blue
White
Gray
Red
Right
3 spot:
Color indicator
Model label
Color indicator
Model label
Front speaker
Center speaker
Surround speaker
Left
Blue
White
Green
Gray
Red
Green
Right
Screw
Center
speaker
Front
speaker
Surround
speaker
Bracket
5 mm to 7 mm
Mounting screw
(not supplied)
5 mm
10 mm
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 9 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Speaker Setup Guide01
10
En
Attaching the brackets only for the
HTZ585DVD-AP
Make sure to tighten the supplied screw as
securely as possible when attaching the
bracket to the back of the speaker.
Please do not attach the brackets to the
center speaker.
Attaching the speakers only for the
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
The front speaker of the HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP can be hung vertically or
horizontally on the wall. Use one hole to hang
it vertically and two holes to hang it
horizontally. When the speaker is horizontally
installed, turn the logo on the front grill side.
The illustration below shows the front right
speaker.
Additional notes on speaker
placement
Install the main front left and right
speakers at an equal distance from the TV.
When using the 5 spot speaker layout,
install the surround speakers slightly
above ear level for optimum effect.
Precautions:
When installing the center speaker on top
of the TV, be sure to secure it with tape or
some other suitable means. Otherwise, the
speaker may fall from the TV due to
external shocks such as earthquakes,
endangering those nearby or damaging
the speaker.
Make sure that all the bare speaker wire is
twisted together and inserted fully into the
speaker terminal. If any of the bare speaker
wire touches the back panel it may cause
the power to cut off as a safety measure.
The front, center and surround speakers
supplied with this system are magnetically
shielded. However, depending on the
installation location, color distortion may
occur if the speaker is installed extremely
close to the screen of a television set. If this
case happens, turn the power switch of the
television set OFF, and turn it ON after
15 min. to 30 min. If the problem persists,
place the speaker system away from the
television set.
The subwoofer is not magnetically shielded
and so should not be placed near a TV or
monitor. Magnetic storage media (such as
floppy discs and tape or video cassettes)
should also not be kept close to the
subwoofer.
Do not attach the center speaker (only of
the HTZ585DVD-AP) and subwoofer to a
wall or ceiling. They may fall off and cause
injury.
Screw
(supplied)
01 Speaker_Setup.fm 10 ページ 2009年4月16日 木曜日 午後8時52分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Connecting up 02
11
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Chapter 2
Connecting up
Basic connections
For the best surround sound, setup your speakers as below. The speakers in the illustration below
are the HTZ585DVD-AP.
Important
When connecting this system or changing
connections, be sure to switch power off
and disconnect the power cord from the
wall socket.
After completing all connections, connect
the power cords to the wall socket.
WARNING
Pioneer bears no responsibility for
accidents resulting from faulty assembly or
installation, insufficient mounting strength
of walls, mounting fixtures (or other
building fixtures), misuse or natural
disasters.
1 Assemble the AM loop antenna.
a. Bend the stand in the direction indicated by
the arrow.
b. Clip the loop onto the stand.
c. If you want to fix to a wall or other surface,
perform step b after first securing the
stand with screws.
It is recommended that you determine the
reception strength before securing the
stand with the screws.
AC IN
HDMI OUT
ANALOG AUDIO IN
SPEAKERS (4 Ω )
LINE 2
L
R
Y
P
B
P
R
LR
FRONT
CENTER
LR
SURROUND
SUB
WOOFER
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO(TV)
COMPONENT
VIDEO
A
N
T
E
N
N
A
FM
UNBAL 75 Ω AM LOOP
ADAPTER PORT
OPTICAL
LINE 1
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
Surround right
(Grey)
Front right
(Red)
Front left
(White)
Subwoofer
(Purple)
Center
(Green)
Surround left
(Blue)
Listening position
TV
To video input
FM antenna
AM loop antenna
fig. a fig. b
fig. c
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 11 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Connecting up02
12
En
2 Connect the AM and FM antennas.
1
a. Pull off the protective shields of both AM
antenna wires. Connect one wire of the AM
loop antenna to each AM antenna
terminal.
2
For each terminal, press down on the tab to
open; insert the wire, then release to secure.
b. Push the FM antenna
3
plug onto the center
pin of the FM antenna socket.
3-1 Connect each speaker.
Connect the wires to the speaker.
Twist and pull off the protective shields on
each wire.
Match the color-coded wire with the color
indicator on the label, then insert the color-
coded wire into the red (+) side and the
other wire into the black (–) side.
HTZ585DVD-AP only:
a. When connecting the center speakers,
connect the Y-cable dual end to the two
center speakers in the same way.
When you select a 4-spot, 3-spot or 2-spot
layout where the brackets are used for
assembling, also follow step b below.
b. When connections are completed, secure
the speaker cables. Fix the cables to the
groove in the brackets.
Note
1 Keep antenna cables away from the receiver and other cables.
• If reception with the supplied antenna is poor, see Improving poor FM reception on page 20.
• Do not attach any antenna other than the provided loop antenna, or an external antenna as described on page 45.
2 Don’t let it come into contact with metal objects and avoid placing near computers, television sets or other electrical
appliances.
• If radio reception is poor, you may be able improve it by re-inserting each antenna wire into the opposite terminal.
• For best reception, do not untwist the AM loop antenna wires or wrap them around the loop antenna.
3 To ensure optimum reception, make sure the FM antenna is fully extended and not coiled or hanging at the rear of
the unit.
1
2
3
Color-coded wire
(Connect to speaker)
Color-coded connector
(Connect to rear panel)
Black (–)
Color-coded wire
Red (+)
Y-cable
To Main Unit
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 12 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Connecting up 02
13
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
3-2 Connect each speaker terminals on the
receiver.
Connect the other end to the color-coded
speaker terminals on the rear of the
receiver. Make sure to insert completely.
The small lug at the wire-end of the speaker
plug should face up or down depending on
whether it’s being plugged into one of the
upper or lower speaker terminals. Please
make sure to connect correctly.
CAUTION
These speaker terminals carry
HAZARDOUS LIVE voltage. To prevent
the risk of electric shock when connecting
or disconnecting the speaker cables,
disconnect the power cord before touching
any uninsulated parts.
Do not connect any speakers other than
those supplied to this system.
Do not connect the supplied speakers to
any amplifier other than the one supplied
with this system. Connection to any other
amplifier may result in malfunction or fire.
After connecting the plugs, pull lightly on
the cables to make sure that the ends of
the cables are securely connected to the
terminals. Poor connections can create
noise and interruptions on the sound.
If the cable’s wires happen to be pushed
out of the terminals, allowing the wires to
come into contact with each other, it
places an excessive additional load on the
amp. This may cause the amp to stop
functioning, and may even damage the
amp.
4 Connect one end to a video input on your
TV.
Use the supplied video cable.
5
Connect the other end to the video
output of the receiver.
This unit is equipped with copy protection
technology. Do not connect this unit to
your TV via a VCR using AV cables, as the
picture from this unit will not appear
properly on your TV.
6 Connect the power cord.
1
Connect the power cord to AC inlet on the
receiver. Connect the power cord to a wall
socket.
Upper terminal Lower terminal
Note
1 Do not use any power cord other than the one supplied with this system.
• Do not use the supplied power cord for any purpose other than connecting to this system.
AC IN
To AC outlet
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 13 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Controls and displays03
14
En
Chapter 3
Controls and displays
Front panel
The illustration shows the HTZ585DVD-AP/
HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP.
1
STANDBY/ON
(page 17, 18, 33, 46, 55
and 57)
Switches the system on or into standby.
2
OPEN/CLOSE
(page 19, 33 and 56)
Opens/closes the disc tray.
3Function
4
5
6
VOLUME +/–
(page 19)
7 Disc tray (page 19)
8 Power indicator (Blue)
9 Remote Sensor (page 16)
10 Display
11
USB
interface (page 32)
12
MIC
input jacks (page 34)
MCACC jack (HTZ585DVD-AP/
HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP) (page 18)
13 PHONES jack (page 24)
Display
1 Decord indicators (page 22)
DTS lights during playback of a DTS source.
2PL II lights during 2Dolby Pro Logic II
decoding and 2D lights during playback of
Dolby Digital sources.
2 PRGSVE (page 43)
Lights when progressive scan video signal is
given from the component video output
terminal.
3
SOUND
(page 24)
Lights when the Sound Retriever is active.
4
SURR.
(page 22 and 24)
Lights when one of the Advanced Surround
modes or PHONESUR (virtual surround
sound for headphones) mode is selected.
F.SURR.
(page 23)
Lights when one of the Front Stage
Surround Advance mode is selected.
5
RPT
and
RPT
-1 (page 29)
RPT lights during repeat play. RPT-1 lights
during repeat one-track play.
6
PGM
(page 28 and 30)
Lights during program play.
7 Tuner indicators (page 20)
Lights when a broadcast is being received,
Lights when a stereo FM broadcast is
being received, Lights when FM mono
reception is selected .
8
RDM
(page 29)
Lights during random play.
USB
PHONES
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
USB
OPEN/CLOSE
STANDBY/ON
FUNCTION
VOLUME

MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
PHONES
11 13
521
7 8
9
10
3 4
6
12
PRGSVE SOUND
DTS F.SURR.
2PL
2D
RPT -1
kHz
PGM
MHz RDM
6
12 89 7
5
11
3
10
21 4
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 14 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Controls and displays 03
15
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
9 kHz/MHz
Indicates the frequency unit shown in the
character display (kHz for AM, MHz for FM).
10 Character display
11 (page 51)
Lights when sleep timer is active.
12
Lights during playback.
Remote control
The illustration shows the HTZ585DVD-AP/
HTZ787DVD-AP.
1
STANDBY/ON
(page 17, 18, 33, 46, 55
and 57)
2 Function select buttons
3 Number buttons
CLEAR
DISPLAY (page 31)
SHIFT+SLEEP (
page 51
)
SHIFT+USB REC (page 33)
SHIFT+AUDIO (page 31)
SHIFT+SUBTITLE (page 31)
SHIFT+ANGLE (page 31)
SHIFT+ZOOM (page 31)
4
TOP MENU
(page 20 and
31
)
SHIFT+SETUP (
page 17
,
20
, 21,
44
,
46
,
47
,
49
,
50
and
60
)
5 Cursor buttons
ENTER
TUNE (page 20)
PRESET (page 21)
6HOME MENU
SHIFT+MCACC (HTZ585DVD-AP/
HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP only)
(page 18)
7 Sound controls
AUTO
/
STEREO (page 22 and 24)
SURROUND (page 22, 23 and 24)
SOUND (page 24 and 25)
SOUND RETRIEVER (page 24)
8 Playback controls (page 19 and 26)
9 TV CONTROL buttons
These control Pioneer flat screen TVs.
1
10
SHIFT
11
OPEN/CLOSE
(page 19, 33 and 56)
12 PLAYLIST buttons (page 28)
1
USB REC
CLEAR
TOP MENU
TUNE
ECHO
TUNE
MCACC
KARAOKE
MENU
MIC VOL
PLAYLIST
OPEN/CLOSE
RETURN
SETUP
AUTO/
STEREO
SOUND
RETRIEVERSURROUND
SOUND
CLASS
VOLUMECHANNEL
T V CONTROL
INPUT
SHIFT VOLUME
MUTE
T.EDIT
PRESET PRESET
AUDIO
ANGLE
SLEEP
SUBTITLE
ADAPTER PORT
USB LINE
TUNER
(
FM/AM
)
DVD/CD
STANDBY
/ON
ZOOM
DISPLAY
23
456
789
0
HOME
MENU
1
2
3
ENTER
1
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2
11
12
13
15
16
17
18
14
Note
1 Hold down the number button 1 for over three seconds with the CLEAR pressed. If the TV refuses to respond, hold down the
number button 2. After control is properly switched over, the power to the TV can be operated by directing the TV CONTROL
toward the TV and pressing it.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 15 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Controls and displays03
16
En
13
MIC VOL +/–
(page 34)
14 MENU (page 20, 27 and 31)
15 RETURN
16 Tuner controls
CLASS (page 21)
SHIFT+T.EDIT (page 21)
17
MUTE
18
VOLUME +/–
(page 19)
Putting the batteries in the remote
control
1 Open the battery compartment cover
on the back of the remote control.
2 Insert two AA/R6 batteries into the
battery compartment following the
indications (, ) inside the compartment.
3 Close the cover.
CAUTION
Incorrect use of batteries can result in hazards
such as leakage and bursting. Please observe
the following:
Always insert batteries into the battery
compartment correctly matching the
positive and negative polarities, as
shown by the display inside the
compartment.
Never mix new and used batteries.
Batteries of the same size may have
different voltages, depending on brand. Do
not mix different brands of batteries.
When disposing of used batteries, please
comply with governmental regulations or
environmental public instruction’s rules
that apply in your country or area.
In order to prevent battery leakage, remove
the batteries when not using the remote
control for an extended period (one month
or more). If leakage occurs, carefully wipe
away any battery fluid inside the
compartment, and replace the batteries
with new ones.
Do not allow books or other objects to rest
on top of the remote control, since the
buttons may be depressed, causing faster
exhaustion of the batteries.
Do not use or store batteries in direct
sunlight or excessively hot places, such as
inside a car or near a heater. This can
cause batteries to leak, overheat, explode
or catch fire. It can also reduce the life or
performance of batteries.
Using the remote control
The remote control can be used within a range
of about 7 meters from the remote sensor on
the front panel, and within a 30 degree angle.
The remote control may not work if there is
an obstacle between the remote control
and the display unit, or if the remote
control is not directed towards the remote
sensor of the display unit at the correct
angle.
The remote control may not work properly if
strong light such as direct sunlight or
fluorescent light is shining onto the unit’s
remote sensor.
The remote control may not work properly
when this unit is used near devices
emitting infrared rays, or when remote
controls of other devices which use
infrared rays are used. Also, the use of this
remote control may cause other devices to
work improperly.
When the operating range of the remote
becomes too short, replace the batteries.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 16 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Getting started 04
17
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Chapter 4
Getting started
Setting Speaker Layout
Not applicable to the HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP model
Select the speaker layout for the speaker
setting you arranged to your listening area
environment.
First time you switch on the system, the
following speaker layout setting appears. If you
switch off the system without finishing this
setting, the same appears again next time you
switch on the system.
1 Press
STANDBY/ON
and confirm
WELCOME is shown on the display.
2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT will run on
the display for about 10 seconds.
3Use / to select appropriate speaker
layout.
The speaker layouts you can select vary with
the model to be used.
See the Setup Guide for more details about
speaker layout and mode description.
5 SPOT – Optimal for 5.1 channel home
theater sound by placing the two surround
speakers in the rear of the listening position.
4 SPOT (HTZ585DVD-AP only) – This is
the standard layout for listening to the
surround sound, which is similar to the 5
spot speaker layout. The two center
speakers are separated to the right and left
sides, and neatly arranged around the TV.
3 SPOT – This is the classic layout for the
Front Surround mode. The two surround
speakers are placed in front of the listening
position.
2 SPOT (HTZ585DVD-AP only) – This
layout for the Front Surround mode is the
same as the 3 spot speaker layout. The two
center speakers are separated to the right
and left sides, and neatly arranged around
the TV.
4 Press ENTER to confirm.
1
Using the Auto MCACC setup for
optimal surround sound
Not applicable to theHTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP model
The Multichannel Acoustic Calibration (MCACC)
system measures the acoustic characteristics of
your listening area, taking into account ambient
noise and testing for channel delay and channel
level. After you have set up the microphone
provided with your system, the receiver uses the
information from a series of test tones to
measure reverb, optimizing the speaker settings
and equalization (Acoustic Calibration EQ) for
your particular room.
2
Important
These test tones are loud; however, do not
turn the volume down during setup as this
may result in a sub-optimal calibration.
Make sure the mic and speakers are not
moved during the MCACC setup.
Note
1 To change the setting, press SHIFT+SETUP, use / to select SYS SET, then use / to select LAYOUT to start setting
procedure.
2 You only need to use the Auto MCACC setup once (unless you change the placement of your speakers or your room layout).
1
USB REC
PLAYLIST
OPEN /CLOSE
AUDIO SUBTITLE
ADAPTER PORT
USB
LINE
TUNER
(
FM/AM
)
DVD/CD
STANDBY
/ON
23
456
1
2
3
TOP MENU
TUNE
TUNE
MCACC
MENU
RETURN
SETUP
AUTO/
STEREO
SOUND
RETRIEVERSURROUND
SOUND
PRESET PRESET
HOME
MENU
ENTER
ECHO
KARAOKE
VOLUMECHANNEL
INPUT
SHIFT VOLUME
MUTE
T.EDIT
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 17 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Getting started04
18
En
1 Connect the microphone to the MCACC
MIC jack on the front panel.
2 Place the microphone at your normal
listening position.
Place it about ear height, and make sure it is
level by using a table or chair.
Make sure there are no obstacles between the
speakers and the microphone.
3 If the system is off, press
STANDBY/ON to turn the power on.
When the speaker layout menu appears, see
Setting Speaker Layout on page 17 and select a
proper setting.
4Press SHIFT+MCACC.
Try to be as quiet as possible after pressing
SHIFT+MCACC. The volume increases
automatically and the system outputs a series
of test tones.
Press SHIFT+MCACC to cancel and revert
to the previous Auto MCACC settings.
If the noise level is too high, NOISY blinks
in the display for five seconds. To exit and
check the noise levels
1
, press
SHIFT+MCACC, or to try again, press
ENTER when RETRY shows in the display.
If you see an ERR MIC or ERR SP message
in the display, there may be a problem with
your mic or the speaker connections. To try
again, press ENTER when you see RETRY.
2
When MCACC setup is complete, the volume
level returns to normal and COMPLETE
3
shows
in the display, indicating that the MCACC
setup is complete and Acoustic Calibration EQ
has been activated.
4
Be sure to disconnect the microphone
from this unit upon completion of the Auto
MCACC setup.
Using the on-screen displays
For ease of use, this system makes extensive
use of graphical on-screen displays (OSDs).
All the screens are navigated in basically the
same way, using , , , to change the
highlighted item and pressing ENTER to select
it.
5
Important
Throughout this manual, ‘Select’ means
use the cursor buttons to highlight an item
on-screen, then press ENTER.
Note
1 • If the room environment is not optimal for the Auto MCACC setup (too much ambient noise, echo off the walls, obstacles
blocking the speakers from the microphone) the final settings may be incorrect. Check for household appliances (air conditioner,
fridge, fan, etc.), that may be affecting the environment and switch them off if necessary.
• Some older TVs may interfere with the operation of the mic. If this seems to be happening, switch off the TV during the Auto
MCACC setup.
USB
PHONES
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
2 If this doesn’t work, press SHIFT+MCACC, turn off the power, and check the problem indicated by the error message, then try
the Auto MCACC setup again.
3If COMPLETE doesn’t appear, it is likely an error occurred during the setup. Please check all connections and try again.
4See Listening with Acoustic Calibration EQ on page 24 to switch on/off Acoustic Calibration EQ.
5 The screen saver will appear after five minutes of inactivity.
Button What it does
HOME
MENU
Displays/exits the on-screen display
 Changes the highlighted menu item
ENTER
Selects the highlighted menu item
RETURN
Returns to the main menu without
saving changes
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 18 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Getting started 04
19
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Tip
The button guide at the bottom of every
OSD screen shows you which buttons
you’ll need to use for that screen.
Playing discs
The basic playback controls for playing DVD, CD,
Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV and
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs are covered here.
Further functions are detailed in chapter 6.
1 If the player isn’t already on, switch it on.
If you’re playing a disc with video, also turn on
your TV and make sure that it is set to the
correct video input.
2 Press
OPEN/CLOSE
to load a disc.
Load a disc with the label side facing up, using
the disc tray guide to align the disc (if you’re
loading a double-sided DVD disc, load it with
the side you want to play face down).
3 Press
(play) to start playback.
If you’re playing a DVD or Video CD/Super VCD,
a menu may appear. See DVD-Video disc
menus and Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus on
page 20 to navigate these.
If you loaded a disc containing JPEGs, a
slideshow will start. See Playing a JPEG
slideshow on page 26 for more on this.
If a disc contains a mixture of DivX video/
WMV and other media file types (MP3, for
example), first select whether to play the
DivX video/WMV files (DivX/WMV) or the
other media file types (MP3/WMA/JPEG/
MPEG-4 AAC) from the on-screen display.
4 Adjust the volume.
Use the VOLUME +/– control.
Basic playback controls
The following table shows the basic controls on
the remote for playing discs.
1
You can find
other playback features in chapter 6.
Resume and Last Memory
When you stop playback of a disc, RESUME
shows in the display indicating that you can
resume playback from that point.
With DVDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, even if
ejected, the play position is stored in memory.
2
The next time you load the disc, the display
shows LAST MEM and you can resume play-
back.
If you want to clear the resume point, press
(stop) while RESUME is displayed.
Note
1 You may find with some DVD discs that some playback controls don’t work in certain parts of the disc.
Button What it does
Starts/resumes normal playback.
If the display shows RESUME or
LAST MEM playback starts from the
resume or last memory point (see
Resume and Last Memory below).
Pauses/unpauses a disc.
Stops playback or cancels the resume
function (if the display shows
RESUME
).
Press to start fast reverse scanning.
Press to start fast forward scanning.
Skips to the start of the current track or
chapter, then previous tracks/chapters.
Skips to the next track or chapter.
Numbers
Use to enter a title/chapter/track
number. Press
ENTER to select.
• If the disc is stopped, playback starts
from the selected title (for DVD) or
track (for CD/Video CD/Super VCD).
If the disc is playing, playback jumps to
the start of the selected title (VR mode
DVD-R/-RW), chapter (DVD-Video) or
track (CD/Video CD/Super VCD).
2 • The Resume and the Last Memory functions may not work with some discs.
• For DVD-Video discs (except VR mode DVD-R/-RW), the player stores the play position of the last five discs.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 19 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Getting started04
20
En
DVD-Video disc menus
Many DVD-Video discs contain menus from
which you can select what you want to watch.
Sometimes DVD-Video menus are displayed
automatically when you start playback; others only
appear when you press MENU or TOP MENU.
Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus
Some Video CD/Super VCDs have menus from
which you can choose what you want to watch.
These are PBC (Playback control) menus.
You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD
without having to navigate the PBC menu by
starting playback using a number button to
select a track, rather than the (play) button.
Listening to the radio
The tuner can receive both FM and AM
broadcasts, and lets you memorize your
favorite stations so you don’t have to manually
tune in every time you want to listen.
1 Press
TUNER
to switch to the tuner, then
press repeatedly to select the AM or FM band.
The display shows the band and frequency.
2 Tune to a frequency.
There are three tuning modes — manual, auto,
and high-speed:
Manual tuning: Press TUNE repeatedly to
change the displayed frequency.
Auto tuning: Press and hold TUNE until
the frequency display starts to move, then
release. The tuner will stop on the next
station it finds. Repeat to keep searching.
High-speed tuning: Press and hold
TUNE until the frequency display starts to
move rapidly. Keep the button held down
until you reach the frequency you want. If
necessary, fine tune the frequency using
the manual tuning method.
Improving poor FM reception
If you’re listening to an FM station in stereo but
the reception is weak, you can improve the
sound quality by switching to mono.
1 Tune to an FM radio station then press
SHIFT+SETUP
.
2Use
/
to choose TUNERSET then press
ENTER
.
3Use
/
to choose FM MODE then press
ENTER
.
4Use
/
to select
FM MONO
then press
ENTER
.
The mono indicator ( ) lights when the tuner
is in mono reception mode.
Select FM AUTO above to switch back to auto-
stereo mode (the stereo indicator ( ) lights
when receiving a stereo broadcast).
Button What it does
TOP MENU
Displays the ‘top menu’ of a DVD
disc — this varies with the disc.
MENU
Displays a DVD disc menu — this
varies with the disc and may be
the same as the ‘top menu’.
 Moves the cursor around the
screen.
ENTER
Selects the current menu option.
RETURN
Returns to the previously
displayed menu screen.
Numbers Highlights a numbered menu
option (some discs only). Press
ENTER to select.
Button What it does
RETURN
Displays the PBC menu.
Numbers Selects numbered menu options.
Press
ENTER to select.
Displays the previous menu page
(if there is one).
Displays the next menu page
(if there is one).
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 20 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Getting started 04
21
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Reducing AM reception noise
If AM reception seems particularly poor, or the
AM radio station you’re listening to seems
noisy, try using the Noise Cut feature for better
sound quality.
1 Tune to an AM radio station then press
SHIFT+SETUP.
2Use
/
to choose
TUNERSET
then
press ENTER.
3Use
/
to choose NOISECUT then press
ENTER.
4Use
/
to select the noise cut mode
then press
ENTER
.
Select an effect level between 1 or 2.
Memorizing stations
This system can memorize up to 30 stations,
stored in three banks, or classes (A, B and C) of
10 stations each.
1 Tune to an AM or FM radio station.
Select mono or auto-stereo reception (FM) as
necessary. These settings are saved along with
the preset.
2 Press
SHIFT+T.EDIT
.
3 Press
CLASS
to select one of the three
classes, then use the
PRESET
buttons to select
the station preset you want.
You can also use the number buttons to select
a preset.
4 Press
ENTER
.
After pressing ENTER, the preset class and
number stop blinking and the system
memorize station.
Listening to station presets
You will need to have some presets stored to do
this.
1 Make sure the
TUNER
function is
selected.
2 Press
CLASS
to select the class in which
the channel is stored. Press repeatedly to
cycle through classes A, B and C.
3Use the
PRESET
buttons to select a station
preset.
You can also use the number buttons to do
this.
Audio input settings from the
TVs (TV Input)
To listen to audio from a flat screen TV on this
device, you will need to connect an audio cable
other than an HDMI cable. From this menu, set
the audio input to that which you would like to
connect. This setting is effective only when
KURO LINK is set to LINK ON and this unit is
connected with a KURO LINK-compatible
Pioneer flat screen TV (see KURO LINK Setup
on page 48).
Select from inputs DIGITAL AUDIO (LINE1)
and ANALOG AUDIO (LINE2).
1Press
SHIFT+SETUP
and use
/
to
select
SYS SET
then press
ENTER
.
2
Use / to
select
TV INPUT
, then press
ENTER
.
3
Use / to
adjust the setting then press
ENTER
to confirm.
Listening to other sources
You can connect auxiliary sources (TV, satellite
receiver, etc.) to this unit for playback through
the speaker system. See Connecting using the
component video output on page 43 for more
on this.
To connect a USB device to the USB
terminal, see USB playback and Recording
on page 32.
HTZ585/787/FS30DVD-AP only:
Bluetooth ADAPTER is selectable when it is
plugged and detected. See Bluetooth
®
ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of Music
on page 45 for more on this.
1 Make sure that the external source (TV,
satellite receiver, etc.) is switched on.
2Press
LINE
to select the source.
Each press switches between LINE
1
and
LINE
2
.
3 If necessary, start playback of the source.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 21 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Listening to your system05
22
En
Chapter 5
Listening to your system
Important
This unit’s audio function may be restricted
depending on the sound source and HDMI
audio setting (page 44). In this event, the
menus may not appear, or a message may
be displayed instead (page 59).
Selecting Listening mode
Various listening modes are available for
enjoyment of diverse sound effects and for
sound field correction according to your
preference. Depending on the speaker layout
you have chosen in the Home theater sound
setup on page 6, the listening mode you can
set differs. Read the following and proceed
with each setting.
5 spot/4 spot speaker layout
When you have chosen 5 spot/4 spot speaker
layout, select one listening mode from the
surround sound mode. See Listening in
surround sound below.
3 spot/2spot speaker layout
When you have chosen 3 spot/2 spot speaker
layout, select one listening mode from the
Front Stage Surround Advance mode. See
Using Front Stage Surround Advance on
page 23.
Auto listening mode
The Auto listening mode is the simplest way to
listen to any source as it was mastered: the
output from the speakers mirrors the channels
in the source material.
Press
AUTO/STEREO
to select the AUTO
listening mode.
1
The mode is automatically selected according
to the speaker layout setting.
2
Listening in surround sound
For HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP:
When you set up the system for 5 spot/4 spot
speaker layout, the surround sound mode is
available.
You can listen to stereo or multichannel source
in surround sound. Surround sound is
generated from stereo sources using one of
the Dolby Pro Logic decoding modes.
Press
SURROUND
repeatedly to select a
listening mode.
1
The choices that appear in the display will vary
according to the type of source that’s playing.
STANDARD – Standard decoding mode
(This mode can be selected only when the
source is multi channel)
MOVIE (Dolby Pro Logic II Movie) – Pro
Logic II 5.1 channel surround sound,
especially suited to movie sources (use
with any Two-channel source)
Note
1 If the source is Dolby Digital or DTS, the corresponding indicator lights in the front panel display.
Source
5 SPOT
4 SPOT
3 SPOT
2 SPOT
two-ch STEREO STEREO
multi-ch STANDARD FOCUS5.1
Dolby
surround
MOVIE FOCUS5.1
2 HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP only: Two-channel is set to STEREO, and multichannel and Dolby Surround are set to FOCUS.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 22 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Listening to your system 05
23
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
MUSIC (Dolby Pro Logic II Music) – Pro
Logic II 5.1 channel surround sound,
especially suited to music sources (use
with any two-channel source)
DOLBY PL (Dolby Pro Logic) – 4.1 channel
surround sound (use with any two-channel
source)
Each mode shown below is a Pioneer original
sound field mode and is called an “Advanced
Surround” mode.
ACTION – Designed for action movies with
dynamic soundtracks
UNPLUGED – Suitable for acoustic music
sources
EXPANDED – Creates an extra wide stereo
field.
TV SURR – Provides surround sound for
both mono and stereo TV sources.
SPORTS – Suitable for sports programs
ADV.GAME – Suitable for video games
X-STEREO (Extended Stereo)– Gives
multichannel sound to a stereo source,
using all of your speakers.
Dolby Pro Logic II Music settings
When listening in Dolby Pro Logic II Music
mode, there are three settings you can adjust:
Center Width, Dimension, and Panorama.
1 With Dolby Pro Logic II Music mode
active, press
SOUND
.
2Use
/
to select C.WIDTH, DIMEN or
PANORAMA then press
ENTER
.
C.WIDTH (Center Width) – Provides a
better blend of the front speakers by
spreading the center channel between the
front right and left speakers, making it
sound wider (higher settings) or narrower
(lower settings).
DIMEN (Dimension) – Adjusts the depth of
the surround sound balance from front to
back, making the sound more distant
(minus settings), or more forward (positive
settings).
PANORAMA – Extends the front stereo
image to include the surround speakers for
a ‘wraparound’ effect.
3Use
/
to adjust each setting.
C.WIDTH is adjusted within a range of 0
and 7.
DIMEN is adjusted within a range of –3
and +3.
•For PANORAMA, select from PNRM OFF
and PNRM ON.
4Press
ENTER
to confirm.
Using Front Stage Surround
Advance
The Front Stage Surround Advance modes are
effective when you are using the 3spot/2spot
speaker layout as described on page 17.
•Press
SURROUND
repeatedly to select a
Front Stage Surround Advance mode.
FOCUS5.1 – Use to provide a rich surround
sound effect directed to the center area
where the left and right speakers’ sound
projection converges.
WIDE5.1 – Use to provide a surround
sound effect to a wider area than
FOCUS5.1 mode.
EXTRAPWR – Outputs stereo sound (in the
case of multi-channel sources,
down-mixed stereo sound) from the
surround speakers for powerful stereo
effect.
Only for HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP:
FOCUS – equivalent to FOCUS5.1 above
WIDE – equivalent to WIDE5.1 above
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 23 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Listening to your system05
24
En
Listening in stereo
You can listen to any source — stereo or
multichannel — in stereo. When playing a
multichannel source, all channels are
downmixed to the front left/right speakers and
the subwoofer.
In the Auto level control stereo mode (A.L.C.),
this unit equalizes playback sound levels if
each sound level varies with the music source
recorded in a portable audio player.
Press
AUTO/STEREO
repeatedly to select
STEREO or A.L.C. mode.
Listening with headphones
When headphones are connected, only the
STEREO
(default),
A.L.C.
or PHONESUR (virtual
surround sound for headphones) modes are
available.
With headphones connected, press
AUTO/STEREO
or
SURROUND
to select
STEREO, A.L.C. or
PHONESUR
.
Listening with Acoustic
Calibration EQ
You can listen to sources using the Acoustic
Calibration Equalization set in Using the Auto
MCACC setup for optimal surround sound on
page 17.
1
1 Press
SOUND
and use
/
to select
MCACC EQ then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to select EQ ON or EQ OFF
then
press ENTER to confirm
.
•If you select EQ OFF, equalization is set to
off but speaker settings (channel delay and
channel level) remain in effect.
EQ ON
is selected automatically after the
Auto MCACC setup is completed.
Using the Sound Retriever
When audio data is removed during the WMA/
MP3/MPEG-4 AAC compression process,
sound quality often suffers from an uneven
sound image. The Sound Retriever feature
employs new DSP technology that helps bring
CD quality sound back to compressed two-
channel audio by restoring sound pressure
and smoothing jagged artifacts left over after
compression.
While listening to a stereo source, press
SOUND RETRIEVER to select RTRV ON or
RTRV OFF.
Enhancing dialogue
The Dialogue Enhancement feature is
designed to make the dialogue stand out from
other background sounds in a TV or movie
soundtrack.
1Press
SOUND
and use
/
to select
DIALOGUE
then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to select the amount of
dialogue enhancement then press
ENTER
to
confirm.
Select between OFF, MID, MAX or AUTO.
Using the Tone controls
You can change the tonal balance of the sound
by using the tone control menu.
1Press
SOUND
and use
/
to select
TONE then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to select the option you want
to adjust and press
ENTER
.
The Bass/Treble, Quiet and Midnight features
cannot be used at the same time.
Note
1 Acoustic Calibration EQ is not available when headphones are connected.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 24 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Listening to your system 05
25
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Adjusting the bass and treble
Use the tone controls to adjust the bass and
treble.
•Use
/
to select BASS or TREBLE then
use
/
to adjust the tone.
Press ENTER to
confirm
.
Bass and Treble can be adjusted from
–6dB
to
+6dB
.
Quiet and Midnight modes
The Quiet listening feature reduces excessive
bass or treble in a sound source.
The Midnight listening feature allows you to
hear effective surround sound of movies at low
volume levels.
After pressing
ENTER, the setting
switches on/off.
To cancel the Quiet or Midnight listening
modes, select BASS/TRE.
Boosting the bass level
There are two bass modes you can use to
enhance the bass in a source.
1
1 Press
SOUND
and use
/
to select
BASSMODE then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to adjust the sound
then press
ENTER to confirm
.
Select between OFF, MUSIC, CINEMA or
AUTO.
Note
1 The Bass Mode is not available when headphones are connected.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 25 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features06
26
En
Chapter 6
Disc playback features
Important
Many of the functions covered in this
chapter apply to DVD discs, Video CDs/
Super VCDs, CDs, DivX video/WMV and
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC/JPEG discs,
although the exact operation of some
varies slightly with the kind of disc loaded.
Some DVDs restrict the use of some
functions (random or repeat, for example)
in some or all parts of the disc. This is not a
malfunction.
When playing Video CD/Super VCDs, some
of the functions are not available during
PBC playback. If you want to use them,
start the disc playing using a number
button to select a track.
Scanning discs
You can fast-scan discs forward or backward at
various different speeds.
1
During playback, press
or
to start
scanning.
Press repeatedly to increase the scanning
speed (shown on-screen).
To resume playback, press (play).
2
Playing in slow motion
You can play DVDs, Video CD/Super VCDs and
DivX video/WMV at four different forward slow
motion speeds. DVD discs can also be played
in reverse slow motion.
1 During playback, press
(pause).
2 Press and hold
/
or
/
until slow
motion playback starts.
Press repeatedly to change the slow motion
speed (shown on-screen).
To resume playback, press (play).
2
Frame advance/frame reverse
You can advance or back up DVD discs frame-
by-frame. With Video CD/Super VCDs and DivX
video/WMV you can only use frame advance.
1 During playback, press
(pause).
2 Press
/
or
/
to reverse or
advance a frame at a time.
To resume playback, press (play).
2
Playing a JPEG slideshow
After loading a disc containing JPEG pictures,
press to start a slideshow from the first
folder/picture on the disc.
3
The player displays
the pictures in each folder in alphabetical
order.
If the disc contains WMA/MP3/MPEG-4
AAC files, playback of the slideshow and
audio files repeats. During audio playback,
you can still use the skip (/), scan
(/) and pause () functions.
Pictures are automatically adjusted so that
they fill as much of the screen as possible.
Note
1 Only one speed is available for DivX video/WMV discs.
2 • Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatically resume when a new chapter is reached on a DVD disc.
• For Video CDs/Super VCDs in PBC mode and WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC tracks (in Scan mode only), normal playback resumes
when you reach the beginning or the end of track.
3 • The time it takes for the player to load a file increases with large file sizes.
• Discs can contain up to 299 folders and up to 648 folders and files combined.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 26 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features 06
27
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
While the slideshow is running:
Browsing DVD or Video CD/
Super VCD discs with the Disc
Navigator
Use the Disc Navigator to browse through the
contents of a DVD or Video CD/Super VCD disc
to find the part you want to play.
1 During playback, press HOME MENU
and select ‘Disc Navigator’ from the on-
screen menu.
2 Select a view option.
The options available depend on the kind of
disc loaded and whether the disc is playing or
not, but include:
Title – Titles from a DVD-Video disc.
Chapter – Chapters from the current title
of a DVD-Video disc.
Track – Tracks from a Video CD/Super VCD
disc.
Time – Thumbnails from a Video CD/Super
VCD disc at 10 minute intervals.
Original: Title – Original titles from a VR
mode DVD-R/-RW disc.
Playlist: Title – Playlist titles from a VR
mode DVD-R/-RW disc.
Original: Time – Thumbnails from the
Original content at 10 minute intervals.
Playlist: Time – Thumbnails from the
Playlist at 10 minute intervals.
The screen shows up to six moving thumbnail
images displayed one after another. To display
the previous/next six thumbnails, press /
.
3 Select the thumbnail image for what
you want to play.
You can use either /// and ENTER to
select a thumbnail, or the number buttons.
To select using the number buttons, enter a
two-digit number then press ENTER.
Button What it does
Pauses the slideshow (or audio);
press again to restart.
Jumps to the previous picture (or
audio file with audio playback).
Jumps to the next picture (or
audio file with audio playback).
///
Pauses the slideshow and
rotates/flips the displayed
picture (Press (play) to restart
slideshow).
SHIFT+
ZOOM
Pauses the slideshow and zooms
the picture. Press again to toggle
between 1x, 2x and 4x zoom
(Press (play) to restart
slideshow).
MENU
Displays the Disc Navigator
screen (see below).
Disc Navigator
Disc Navigator
Title
Chapter
01
04
02
05
03
06
Disc Navigator: Title
01- 49: - -
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 27 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features06
28
En
Browsing Windows Media
TM
Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG-4
AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG
files with the Disc Navigator
Use the Disc Navigator to find a particular file
or folder by filename.
1 Press HOME MENU and select ‘Disc
Navigator’ from the on-screen menu.
2Use /// and ENTER to navigate.
Use / to move up and down the folder/file
list.
Use to return to the parent folder.
1
Use ENTER or to open a highlighted folder.
When a JPEG file is highlighted, a
thumbnail image is displayed on the right.
3 To play the highlighted track or DivX
video/WMV file or display the highlighted
JPEG file, press ENTER.
When a WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC or DivX
video/WMV file is selected, playback
begins from that file, and continues until
the end of the folder.
When a JPEG file is selected, a slideshow
begins, starting with that file, and
continues to the end of the folder.
Tip
You can also play a JPEG slideshow while
listening to WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC
playback. Simply select the audio file you
want to listen to followed by the JPEG from
which you want the slideshow to start.
Playback of both the slideshow and the
audio files repeats. Playback controls are
effective for the JPEG slideshow only.
To play the contents of the whole disc
rather than just the current folder, exit the
Disc Navigator and start playback using
the (play) button.
Using Playlists
With this feature, you can make up to three
playlists of 30 files each for discs containing
WMA, MP3, MPEG-4 AAC and JPEG files.
Since this unit will remember all playlists for
the last ten discs you have loaded, this is useful
if you have a large number of files that you want
to organize quickly and easily.
2
Programming playlists
1 With the disc stopped, press HOME
MENU and select ‘Disc Navigator’ from the
on-screen menu.
2 Select the file you want to add to the
playlist.
See Browsing Windows Media
TM
Audio (WMA),
MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG
files with the Disc Navigator above if you don’t
know how to do this.
3 Press
PLAYLIST
1, 2 or 3.
The file is added to the playlist you select.
4 Repeat steps 2 and 3 until you’re done.
Note
1 You can also do this by going to the ‘..’ folder at the top, then pressing ENTER.
File1
File2
File3
File4
File5
Folder2
00:00/ 00:00 0kbps
2 The disc must be loaded for the files in your playlist to play back.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 28 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features 06
29
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Tip
To add files without the on-screen display,
simply press PLAYLIST
1
,
2
or
3
during
normal playback of the file you want
(except when a JPEG slideshow is playing
at the same time as audio).
Listening to playlists
With playback stopped, p
ress
PLAYLIST
1, 2 or 3.
During playback, PGM lights in the front panel
display. If no playlist has been programmed,
NO LIST shows in the display.
If the playlist contains both JPEG and audio
files, playback of the slideshow and audio
files starts.
Clearing files from a playlist
1 Start playback of your playlist.
2 From the ‘Disc Navigator’ screen,
highlight the file you want to remove from
the playlist and press
CLEAR
.
Looping a section of a disc
The A-B Repeat function allows you to specify
two points (A and B) within a track (CD, Video
CD/Super Video CD) or title (DVD) that form a
loop which is played over and over.
1 During playback, press
HOME MENU
and
select ‘
Play Mode
’.
2 Select ‘A-B Repeat’.
3 Press
ENTER
on ‘A(Start Point)’ to set the
loop start point.
4Press
ENTER
on ‘B(End Point)’ to set the
loop end point.
After pressing ENTER, playback jumps back to
the start point and plays the loop.
5 To resume normal playback, select ‘Off’.
Using repeat play
In addition to various repeat play options, it’s
also possible to use repeat play together with
program play (see Creating a program list on
page 30).
1 During playback, press
HOME MENU
and
select ‘
Play Mode
’.
2 Select ‘Repeat’ then select a repeat play
option.
1
If program play is active, select Program
Repeat to repeat the program list, or Repeat
Off to cancel.
For DVD discs, select Title Repeat or
Chapter Repeat.
For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select
Disc Repeat or Track Repeat.
For DivX video/WMV discs, select Title
Repeat (or Repeat Off).
Using random play
Use this function to play titles or chapters
(DVD-Video) or tracks (CD and Video CD/Super
VCD) in a random order.
2
1 During playback, press
HOME MENU
and
select ‘
Play Mode
’.
2 Select ‘Random’ then select an option.
For DVD discs, select Random Title or
Random Chapter.
For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select
On or Off to switch random play on or off.
Play Mode
Note
1 You can’t use repeat play with WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs.
2 • You can set the random play option when a disc is playing or stopped. However, you can’t use random play together with
program play.
• You can’t use random play with VR format DVD-R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while
a DVD disc menu is being displayed.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 29 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features06
30
En
Tip
Use the following controls during random
play:
Random play remains in effect until you
select Random Off from the random play
menu options.
Creating a program list
This feature lets you program the play order of
titles/chapters/tracks on a disc.
1
1 During playback, press
HOME MENU
and
select
Play Mode
’.
2 Select ‘Program’ then select ‘Create/Edit
from the list of program options.
3Use
///
and
ENTER
to select a
title, chapter or track for the current step in
the program list.
For a DVD disc, you can add a title or a
chapter.
For a CD or Video CD/Super VCD, select a
track to add to the program list.
After pressing ENTER to select the title/
chapter/track, the step number automatically
moves down one.
4 Repeat step 3 to build up a program list.
A program list can contain up to 24 steps.
You can insert steps by just highlighting
the position where you want the new step
to appear and entering a title/chapter/track
number.
To delete a step, highlight it and press
CLEAR.
5 To play the program list, press
(play).
Program play remains active until you turn off
program play (see below), erase the program
list (see below), eject the disc or switch off.
Tip
Use the following controls during program
play:
Other functions available from the
program menu
There are a number of other options in the
program menu in addition to Create/Edit.
Playback Start – Starts playback of a
saved program list
Playback Stop – Turns off program play,
but does not erase the program list
Program Delete – Erases the program list
and turns off program play
Searching a disc
You can search DVD discs by title or chapter
number, or by time; CDs and Video CD/Super
VCDs by track number or time; DivX video/
WMV discs by time.
1 Press
HOME MENU
and select ‘
Play
Mode
’.
2 Select ‘Search Mode’.
The search options that appear depend on the
kind of disc loaded.
Button What it does
Selects a new track/title/chapter
at random.
Returns to the beginning of the
current track/title/chapter;
further presses select another
random track/title/chapter.
Note
1 You can’t use Program play with VR format DVD-R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while
a DVD disc menu is being displayed.
Button What it does
HOME
MENU
Save the program list and exit
without starting playback.
Skip to the next step in the
program list.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 30 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Disc playback features 06
31
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
3 Select a search mode.
The disc must be playing in order to use
time search.
4 Use the number buttons to enter a title,
chapter or track number, or a time.
For a time search, enter the number of
minutes and seconds into the currently
playing title (DVD/DivX video/WMV) or
track (CD/Video CD/Super VCD) you want
playback to resume from. For example,
press 4, 5, 0, 0 to have playback start from
45 minutes into the disc. For 1 hour, 20
minutes and 30 seconds, press 8, 0, 3, 0.
5 Press
ENTER
to start playback.
Switching subtitles
Some DVD discs and DivX video discs have
subtitles in one or more languages; the disc
box will usually tell you which subtitle
languages are available. You can switch
subtitle language during playback.
1
Press
SHIFT+SUBTITLE
repeatedly to
select a subtitle option.
To set subtitle preferences, see Language
settings on page 39.
See Displaying DivX subtitle files on
page 53 for more on DivX subtitles.
Switching language/audio
channels
When playing discs recorded with dialogue in
two or more languages, or with dual-mono
audio
2
you can switch these during playback.
3
When playing a Video CD/Super VCD, you can
switch between stereo, just the left channel or
just the right channel.
Press
SHIFT+AUDIO
repeatedly to select
an audio language option.
To set audio language preferences, see
Language settings on page 39.
Zooming the screen
Using the zoom feature you can magnify a part
of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, while
watching a DVD, DivX video/WMV title or Video
CD/Super VCD or playing a JPEG disc.
1 During playback, use the
SHIFT+ZOOM
button to select the zoom factor (Normal, 2x
or 4x).
2Use
///
to change the zoomed
area.
You can change the zoom factor and the
zoomed area freely during playback.
4
Switching camera angles
Some DVD discs feature scenes shot from two
or more angles — check the disc box for
details.
When a multi-angle scene is playing, a
icon appears on screen (this can be switched
off if you prefer — see Display settings on
page 40).
During playback (or when paused), press
SHIFT+ANGLE
to switch angle.
Displaying disc information
Various track, chapter and title information can
be displayed on-screen during playback.
To show/switch/hide the information
displayed, press
DISPLAY
repeatedly.
Limited disc information also appears in the
front panel display. Press DISPLAY to change
the displayed information.
Note
1 Some discs only allow you to change subtitle language from the disc menu. Press TOP MENU or MENU to access.
2 Some Super VCDs have two soundtracks. With these discs you can switch between the two soundtracks as well as individual
channels in each.
3 Some discs only allow you to change audio language from the disc menu. Press TOP MENU or MENU to access.
4 • Since DVD, Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV title and JPEG pictures have a fixed resolution, picture quality will
deteriorate, especially at 4x zoom. This is not a malfunction.
• If the navigation square at the top of the screen disappears, press SHIFT+ZOOM again to display it.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 31 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
USB playback and Recording07
32
En
Chapter 7
USB playback and Recording
Using the USB interface
It is possible to listen to two-channel audio
1
and watch DivX video/WMV/JPEG files using
the USB interface on the front of this unit.
Connect a USB mass storage device
2
as
shown below.
1 With the player switched on, press USB.
Make sure your TV is on and set to the correct
video input.
2 Connect your USB device.
The USB terminal is located on the front panel.
3Press
(play) to start playback.
If your USB device contains JPEGs, a
slideshow will start. See Playing a JPEG
slideshow on page 26 for more on this.
•Make sure USB DATA is showing in the
front panel display (or the system is in
standby) when disconnecting.
Important
If a USB ERR message lights in the display, it
may mean that the power requirements of the
USB device are too high for this player, or that
the device is incompatible. Try the following:
Switch the player off, then on again.
Reconnecting the USB device with the
player switched off.
Selecting to another input source (like
DVD/CD), then back to USB.
Using a dedicated AC adapter (supplied
with the device) for USB power.
If this doesn’t remedy the problem, it is likely
your USB device is incompatible.
Recording the tracks of a
music CD on a USB device
The tracks of a music CD loaded in this unit
can be recorded on a USB connected to the
USB port.
Recording all the tracks
1 Load the music CD.
Press to stop playback.
Note
1 This includes playback of DivX video/WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC files (except files with copy-protection or restricted
playback).
2 • Compatible USB devices include external magnetic hard drives, portable flash memory (particularly keydrives) and digital
audio players (MP3 players) of format FAT16/32. It is not possible to connect this unit to a personal computer for USB playback.
• Pioneer cannot guarantee compatibility (operation and/or bus power) with all USB mass storage devices and assumes no
responsibility for any loss of data that may occur when connected to this unit.
• With large amounts of data, it may take longer for the system to read the contents of a USB device.
• Some USB devices may not be properly recognized.
• Even when they are in a supported format, some files may not play or display depending on the content.
USB
USB
USB mass
storage device
USB
(Type A)
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 32 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
USB playback and Recording 07
33
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
2 Press
SHIFT+USB REC
to display the
‘CD -> USB Rec’ screen.
3 Press
ENTER
to start recording.
Recording starts. The screen shown below is
displayed during recording.
1
Recording specific tracks
1 Load the music CD.
Press to stop playback.
2 Press HOME MENU and select ‘CD ->USB
Rec’.
CD -> USB Rec can only be selected when the
music CD is stopped.
3 Make setting using /// and
ENTER.
4 Select the track you want to record.
Individual — Select one track at a time.
Select All — Select all the tracks.
All Clear — Clear all selected tracks.
5 Select the bit rate (transfer rate).
Select 128 kbps, 192 kbps or 320 kbps.
6 Select ‘
Start’
using the
///
, then
press
ENTER
.
2
Recording starts.
Note
1 Recording cannot be started if there is not enough free space on the USB device. In this case, “Available USB space is low” is
displayed.
CD –> USB Rec
Select Track
Bitrate
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
128kbps
13
055:07
Track Progress
Total Progress
Selected Track
Total T im e
13
055:07
Cancel
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
CD – > USB Rec
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
00
000:00
Select Track
Bitrate
Individual
Select All
All Clear
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
2 • When recording is finished, a folder named “PIONEER” is created automatically on the USB device. The recorded tracks are
stored in this folder.
• Up to 99 “PIONEER” folders can be created.
• Recording is not possible if the USB device contains 300 folders or more.
• When recording on a USB device is under way, all DVD-related key operations are disabled except for the operation of
STANDBY/ON and OPEN/CLOSE buttons and switchover of the functions.
• When the sleep timer is ON, it is cancelled once recording on a USB device is started.
Start
Selected Track
Total Time
01
003:17
Select Track
Bitrate
Individual
Select All
All Clear
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
Start
Selected Track
Total Time
03
012:17
Select Track
Bitrate
128kbps
192kbps
320kbps
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
CD –> USB Rec
Select Track
Bitrate
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
128kbps
03
012:17
Track Progress
Total Progress
Selected Track
Total T im e
03
012:17
Cancel
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
07_playing usb.fm 33 ページ 2009年3月23日 月曜日 午後4時37分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Singing karaoke08
34
En
Chapter 8
Singing karaoke
Singing karaoke
Using the karaoke features you can plug in a
microphone and mix the sound of your own
voice with a backing track.
1
You can select a
backing track from audio sources such as CDs,
DVDs, VCDs or USB devices. Adjust the
microphone level relative to the backing track.
1 Plug in the microphone(s).
If you’re only using one mic, plug it into the
MIC (MAIN) jack. The MIC (SUB) jack can be
used only if MIC (MAIN) is also connected.
If the microphone has an on/off switch,
make sure it’s on.
2 Load a karaoke backing disc.
You can also use tracks on a USB device as
source material for a backing track.
3 Adjust KARAOKE mode settings.
•Press
SHIFT+KARAOKE
to turn KARAOKE
mode on or off for discs that have vocals on
both Left and Right channels:
KARAOKE (Vocal Fade) – Vocals in the
backing track are partially eliminated.
OFF (default) – Switches the Karaoke mode off.
Press
SHIFT+AUDIO
to switch between
audio channels (except Data discs and USB
sources) with discs that have vocal tracks on
only one channel:
Left – Left channel only. Use for tracks that
have a vocal recorded in the right channel.
Right – Right channel only. Use for tracks that
have a vocal recorded in the left channel.
STEREO – Switches the Karaoke mode off.
4 Play the backing track.
5 Adjust the
MIC VOL +/–
to get the sound
you want.
2
To avoid unpleasant feedback, make sure you
don’t point the microphone(s) at the speakers.
3
Changing the vocal mix
Adding some effects to the microphone mix
can sometimes improve the overall sound. You
can choose between three echo levels.
To add effects to the microphone mix,
press
SHIFT+
ECHO.
Pressing repeatedly switches between echo
levels 1 to 3 and off.
Changing the backing track
You may want to lower or raise the pitch of the
backing track to match your vocal range.
4
Press SHIFT+ or SHIFT+ to lower or
raise the pitch of the backing track.
Note
1 • These features are only possible when a microphone is connected. If you try to use SHIFT+KARAOKE, SHIFT+ECHO,
SHIFT+, SHIFT+or MIC VOL when no mic is connected, a NO MIC error message is displayed. Also note that during DVD
playback, when you connect a mic sound settings are automatically switched to STEREO playback and the player downmixes
multichannel sources to 2.1 channels.
• These features are only available with the DVD/CD or USB input functions.
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
2 MIC VOL is set to 0 when you remove the microphone, change the function or turn the power off.
3 Depending on the microphone level, the sound of the disc may distort. If this happens, turn down the volume.
4 This feature is not compatible with DTS signals.
08_sing_karaoke.fm 34 ページ 2009年4月16日 木曜日 午後4時54分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Surround sound settings 09
35
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Chapter 9
Surround sound settings
Using the Sound Setup menu
From the Sound Setup menu you can access
all the surround sound settings of the system,
including channel levels, speaker distances,
dynamic range, CD Type and Sound Field
adjustment. The Auto MCACC feature
(page 17) should give you the best surround
sound setup. However you may find that by
further adjustment of the surround sound
settings you can improve the surround sound
in your listening room.
1 Press
SHIFT+SETUP
and use
/
to
select SOUNDSET then press
ENTER
to choose
the setting you want to adjust.
The available settings are shown in the front
panel display.
1
2Use
/
to adjust then press
ENTER
to
confirm and exit.
Note that using the Auto MCACC (page 17)
again overwrites the speaker settings.
Channel level setting (
CH LEVEL
)
Not applicable to the HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP model
Set the relative channel levels from your main
listening position.
2
Use / to switch between channels in the
following order:
L – Front left speaker
C – Center speaker
R – Front right speaker
SR – Surround right speaker
SL – Surround left speaker
SW – Subwoofer
The channel level range is ±10 dB.
Speaker distance setting (
DISTANCE
)
Not applicable to the HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP model
Specifies the distance from your listening
position to your speakers.
When DISTANCE appears, press ENTER, then
use / to adjust the distance, and
/ to
switch between the following speakers:
L – Front left speaker
C – Center speaker
R – Front right speaker
SR – Surround right speaker
SL – Surround left speaker
SW – Subwoofer
Each speaker can be adjusted between 0.1 m
and 9.0 m. The default setting is 3.0 m.
Dynamic Range Control (
D.R.C.
)
Specifies dynamic range adjustment to Dolby
Digital or some DTS soundtracks. If low level
sound or dialogue seem difficult to hear
properly, this can help by bringing up the low
level sounds, while controlling high level
peaks.
Note
1 The setup menu is exited automatically after five minutes of inactivity.
2 • The Channel level setting is not available when headphones are connected.
• The speaker volume can be adjusted at any time by using VOLUME +/– and then using / to adjust the channel levels.
When TESTTONE is selected, the test tone automatically moves from speaker to speaker in the order listed above. You should
hear the test tone at the same volume from each speaker when seated in the main listening position. Press ENTER when you’re
finished.
• Since the subwoofer produces ultra-low frequencies it may seem quieter than it actually is.
• When the speaker volume is set to 51 or more, TESTTONE cannot be selected and the channel level setting range is
restricted. In addition, if the channel level range of any speaker is set to the + side, the maximum speaker volume is also
restricted.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 35 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Surround sound settings09
36
En
OFF (default) – No dynamic range
adjustment (use when listening at higher
volumes)
MID – Mid setting
HIGH – Dynamic range is reduced (loud
sounds are reduced in volume while
quieter sounds are increased)
DTS CD setting (
CD TYPE
)
If you play a DTS-encoded CD, you will need to
change this setting to hear the decoded signal.
NORMAL – Regular CD playback; some
DTS-encoded CDs output a noisy signal.
DTS-CD – Proper decoding of DTS-
encoded CDs; the beginning of regular CD
tracks may be skipped.
Dual mono setting (
DUALMONO
)
Specifies how dual mono encoded Dolby
Digital soundtracks should be played. This
setting can also be used to change the audio
channels for DVD-RW discs recorded in
bilingual audio, and external inputs with
bilingual audio.
1Press
SHIFT+AUDIO
repeatedly to select a
setting.
Select one of the following while a disc is
playing dual mono audio.
1
CH1 MONO – Only channel 1 is played
CH2 MONO – Only channel 2 is played
CH1/CH2 – Both channels are played
through the front speakers
Effective Sound for optimum sound
(
S.FIELD
)
With the uniquely shaped high-quality
speakers supplied with this unit, the Effective
Sound mode enables the following Pioneer
exclusive audio technologies designed to
maximize the real experience of sound
originally inherent in movies and music.
Turn on the Effective Sound mode under
normal circumstances to maximize the
capabilities of this unit.
2
Dynamic Range Compression
Resuscitates detailed sound susceptible to
ambient noise to create an acoustic
environment where you feel as if you are right
in the action.
Frequency Characteristic Correction
Realizes the playback characteristic optimized
for long hours of listening in addition to the
added features of the supplied speaker units.
EFFECT (Effective Sound) – Plays the sound
with the characteristics optimized for the
included speakers.
DIRECT (Direct Sound) – Turns off the
Effective Sound mode.
Note
1 When DVD function is selected, the displayed setting items are L, R and L+R (displayed on OSD).
2 The Sound Field will not affect the headphone outputs.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 36 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Video Adjust menu 10
37
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Chapter 10
Video Adjust menu
Video Adjust menu
From the Video Adjust screen you can adjust
settings that affect picture presentation.
1 Press
HOME MENU
and select ‘Video
Adjust’ from the on-screen display.
2 Make settings using
///
and
ENTER
.
You can adjust the following settings:
Sharpness – Adjusts the sharpness of
edges in the picture (Fine, Standard, Soft)
Brightness – Adjusts the overall
brightness (–20 to +20)
Contrast – Adjusts the contrast between
light and dark (–16 to +16)
Gamma – Adjusts the ‘warmth’ of the
picture (High, Medium, Low, Off)
Hue – Adjusts the red/green balance
(Green 9 to Red 9)
Chroma Level – Adjusts how saturated
colors appear (–9 to +9)
Adjust the Brightness, Contrast, Hue and
Chroma Level settings using /.
3 Press
ENTER
to return to the Video Adjust
screen, or
HOME MENU
to exit.
Video Adjust
Sharpness
Brightness
Contrast
Gamma
Hue
Chroma Level
Standard
0
0
Off
0
0
Video Adjust
Brightness min max 0
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 37 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Initial Settings menu11
38
En
Chapter 11
Initial Settings menu
Using the Initial Settings menu
The Initial Settings menu provides audio and
video output settings, parental lock settings,
and display settings, among others.
If an option is grayed out it means that it
cannot be changed at the current time. This is
usually because a disc is playing. Stop the
disc, then change the setting.
1 Press
DVD/CD
.
2 With playback stopped, press
HOME
MENU
and select ‘Initial Settings’.
3Use
///
and
ENTER
to select the
setting and option you want to set.
All the settings and options are explained on
the following pages.
1
Digital Audio Out settings
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP only
Video Output settings
Note
1 • In the table, the default setting is shown in bold: other settings are shown in italics.
• Some settings, such as TV Screen, Audio Language and Subtitle Language may be overridden by the DVD disc. Often
these settings can also be made from the DVD disc menu.
• The HDMI Resolution and HDMI Color settings only need to be set if you connected this player to an HDMI-compatible
component using the HDMI connector.
2 This setting can only be used when you are connected via HDMI and have the HDMI resolution set to 1920x1080p, 1920x1080i
or 1280x720p. When using this setting, only the HDMI connection is available.
Initial Settings
Setting Option What it means
Dolby Digital Out Dolby Digital Dolby Digital encoded digital audio is output when playing a
Dolby Digital DVD disc.
Dolby Digital > PCM Dolby Digital audio is converted to PCM audio before being
output.
DTS Out DTS DTS encoded digital audio is output when playing a DTS disc.
(Noise will be output if your amplifier/receiver is not
compatible with DTS audio.)
DTS > PCM No digital audio is output when playing a DTS disc.DTS audio
is converted to PCM audio before being output.
Setting Option What it means
TV Screen
(See also Screen sizes
and disc formats on
page 55.)
4:3 (Letter Box) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widescreen movies are
shown with black bars top and bottom.
4:3 (Pan & Scan) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widescreen movies are
shown with the sides cropped so that the image fills the screen.
16:9 (Wide) Set if you have a widescreen TV.
16:9 (Compressed) Set if you have a widescreen TV. 4:3 material is shown with
black bars on either side of the screen.
2
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 38 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Initial Settings menu 11
39
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Language settings
Component Out
(See also Connecting
using the component
video output on
page 43.)
Interlace Set if your TV is not compatible with progressive scan video.
Progressive Set if your TV is compatible with progressive scan video (see
your TV’s instruction manual for details). Press ENTER once
more to confirm (or RETURN to cancel).
Note that progressive scan video is only output from the
component video jacks.
HDMI Resolution*
(See Connecting using
HDMI on page 44.)
* Default changes with
TV format (PAL/NTSC).
1920x1080p Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pixel progressive-scan video.
1920x1080i Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pixel interlace video.
1280x720p Set if your TV supports 1280 x 720 pixel progressive-scan video.
720x480p (NTSC)/
720x576p (PAL)
Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel
progressive-scan video.
720x480i (NTSC)/
720x576i (PAL)
Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel
interlace video.
HDMI Color*
(See Connecting using
HDMI on page 44.)
* Default changes
depending on device
connected.
Full range RGB If colors are weak, this gives brighter colors and deeper black
(default setting for HDMI-compatible DVI devices).
RGB Use this setting if colors appear overly rich on the Full Range
RGB setting.
Component Outputs 8-bit component video format (default setting for
HDMI-compatible devices).
Setting Option What it means
Audio Language English If there is an English soundtrack on the disc, it is played.
Languages as displayed If there is a language selected on the disc, it is played.
Other Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see
Using the language code list on page 60).
Subtitle Language English If there are English subtitles on the disc they are displayed.
Languages as displayed The subtitle language selected on the disc is displayed.
Other Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see
Using the language code list on page 60).
DVD Menu
Language
w/Subtitle Lang. DVD disc menus are displayed in the same language as your
selected subtitle language, if possible.
Languages as displayed DVD menus are displayed in the selected language, if possible.
Other Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see
Using the language code list on page 60).
Subtitle Display On Subtitles are displayed in your selected subtitle language.
Off Subtitles are always off by default when you play a DVD disc.
Setting Option What it means
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 39 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Initial Settings menu11
40
En
Display settings
Options settings
Parental Lock
Default level: Off; Default password: none;
Default Country/Area code: us (2119)
To give you some control over what your
children watch on your DVD player, some DVD-
Video discs feature a Parental Lock level. If your
player is set to a lower level than the disc, the
disc won’t play.
Some discs also support the Country/Area
Code feature. The player does not play certain
scenes on these discs, depending on the
Country/Area Code you set.
Registering a new password
Register a password to change the Parental
Lock level or enter a Country/Area code.
1
1 Select ‘Password’.
2 Use the number buttons to input a four-
digit password then press
ENTER
.
Changing your password
To change your password, confirm your
existing password then enter a new one.
1 Select ‘Password Change’, input your
existing password, then press
ENTER
.
2 Enter a new password and press
ENTER
.
Setting/changing the Parental Lock
1 Select ‘Level Change’.
2 Use number buttons to enter your
password, then press
ENTER
.
3 Select a new level and press
ENTER
.
Press repeatedly to lock more levels
(more discs will require the password);
press to unlock levels. You can’t lock
level 1.
Setting Option What it means
OSD Language English On-screen displays of the player are in English.
Languages as displayed On-screen displays are shown in the language selected.
Angle Indicator On A camera icon is displayed on-screen during multi-angle
scenes on a DVD disc.
Off No multi-angle indication is shown.
Setting Option What it means
Parental Lock See Parental Lock below.
DivX(R) VOD Display
See About DivX
®
VOD content below.
Note
1 • Not all discs use Parental Lock, and will play without requiring the password.
• If you forget your password, you’ll need to reset the player to register a new password (see Resetting the system on page 60).
Video Output
Language
Display
Options
Parental Lock
DivX (R) VOD
Password
Level Change
Country Code
Initial Settings
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 40 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Initial Settings menu 11
41
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Setting/changing the Country/Area code
You can find the Country/Area code list on
page 61.
1 Select ‘Country Code’, input your
password, then press
ENTER
.
2 Select a Country/Area code then press
ENTER
.
There are two ways you can do this:
Select by code letter: Use / to change
the Country/Area code.
Select by code number: Press then use
the number buttons to enter the four-digit
Country/Area code.
The new Country/Area code takes effect after
ejecting the disc once.
About DivX
®
VOD content
In order to play DivX VOD (video on demand)
content on this player, you first need to register
the player with your DivX VOD content provider.
You do this by generating a DivX VOD registration
code, which you submit to your provider.
1
Important
DivX VOD content is protected by a DRM
(Digital Rights Management) system. This
restricts playback of content to specific,
registered devices.
If you load a disc that contains DivX VOD
content not authorized for your player, the
message Authorization Error is displayed
and the content will not play.
Displaying your DivX VOD registration
code
1 Press HOME MENU and select ‘Initial
Settings’.
2 Select ‘Options’, then ‘DivX (R) VOD’.
3 Select ‘Display’.
Your eight-digit registration code is displayed.
Make a note of the code as you will need it
when you register with a DivX VOD provider.
Playing DivX
®
VOD content
Some DivX VOD content may only be playable
for a fixed number of times. When you load a
disc containing this type of DivX VOD content,
the remaining number of plays is shown on-
screen and you then have the option of playing
the disc (thereby using up one of the remaining
plays), or stopping. If you load a disc that
contains expired DivX VOD content (for
example, content that has zero remaining
plays), the message Rental Expired is
displayed.
If your DivX VOD content allows an unlimited
number of plays, then you may load the disc
into your player and play the content as often
as you like, and no message will be displayed.
Note
1 Resetting the player (as described in Resetting the system on page 60) will not cause you to lose your registration code.
Video Output
Language
Display
Options
Display
Initial Settings
Parental Lock
DivX (R) VOD
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 41 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections12
42
En
Chapter 12
Other connections
Important
When making or changing connections on the rear panel of this unit, be sure to switch power
off and disconnect the power cord from the wall socket.
After completing all connections, connect the power cord to the wall socket.
AC IN
HDMI OUT
Y
P
B
P
R
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO(TV)
COMPONENT
VIDEO
A
N
T
E
N
N
A
FM
UNBAL 75 Ω AM LOOP
ADAPTER PORT
ANALOG AUDIO IN
SPEAKERS (4 Ω )
LINE 2
L
R
LR
FRONT
SUB
WOOFER
OPTICAL
LINE 1
DIGITAL AUDIO IN DIGITAL AUDIO OUT
5 m to 6 m
From
digital output (optical)
From audio output
From
audio output
To
HDMI input
AV receiver
To optical
digital input
To component
input
PAL connector
Outdoor antenna
Indoor antenna
(vinyl-coated wire)
Bluetooth
®
ADAPTER
KURO LINK-compatible
Pioneer flat screen TV
Tape deck, etc.
TV
AM loop antenna
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 42 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections 12
43
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Connecting using the
component video output
If your TV has component video inputs, you can
use these instead of the standard video outputs
for a better quality picture.
1
For the connection diagram, see 3 on page 42.
Use a component video cable to connect
the
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
to a set of
component inputs on your TV.
About progressive scan video
Compared to interlace video, progressive scan
video effectively doubles the scanning rate of
the picture, resulting in a very stable, flicker-
free image. Progressive scan video is available
only from the component video output.
Compatibility of this player with
progressive-scan and high-definition TVs.
This player is compatible with progressive
video Macro Vision System Copy Guard.
2
Connecting for digital audio
This system has optical-type digital inputs. Use
these to connect external components, such
as your digital TV, MD or CD recorder.
For the connection diagram, see 1 on page 42.
Connect the DIGITAL AUDIO IN (LINE1)
jack to the digital output of an external
playback component.
These include digital components such as a
digital TV, an MD player, digital satellite, or a
game system.
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP only:
This system has an optical-type digital output
for providing surround playback.
For the connection diagram, see 5 on page 42.
Connect the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT jack
to the digital input on your multichannel
AV receiver.
Connecting an analog audio
component
You can use the ANALOG AUDIO IN (LINE 2)
jacks to connect an analog audio component,
such as a tape player.
For the connection diagram, see 2 on page 42.
Connect the
ANALOG AUDIO IN (LINE 2)
jacks to the analog outputs of an external
playback component.
Connect using RCA pin-plug stereo cables.
Note
1 • The component video output is switchable between interlaced and progressive formats. See
Video Output settings
on page 38.
• While the player is connected using HDMI cable, the component video output cannot be switched between Interlace and
Progressive formats. When HDMI Resolution is set to 720x480i (NTSC)/720x576i (PAL), Interlace format is automatically
selected, and Progressive format is automatically selected in other settings.
2 Consumers should note that not all high-definition television sets are fully compatible with this product and may cause
artifacts to be displayed in the picture. In case of 525 progressive scan picture problems, it is recommended that the user switch
the connection to the ‘standard definition’ output (Interlace). If there are questions regarding our TV set compatibility with this
model, please contact our customer service center.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 43 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections12
44
En
Connecting using HDMI
If you have a HDMI or DVI (with HDCP)
equipped monitor or display, you can connect
it to this player using a commercially available
HDMI cable for high quality digital video.
1
For the connection diagram, see 4 on page 42.
Use an HDMI cable to connect the HDMI
OUT interconnect on this player to an HDMI
interconnect on a HDMI-compatible monitor.
The arrow on the cable connector body
should be face down for correct alignment
with the connector on the player.
You can also adjust the HDMI settings for
resolution and color. For more on these
settings see Video Output settings on page 38.
Switching the HDMI audio setting
You can select the system speaker or the TV
through the HDMI to output the audio sound of
the DVD/CD or USB function. You cannot use
a number of sound functions of this system
when HDMI audio is set to TV.
1Press
SHIFT+SETUP
.
2Use
/
to select HDMI SET then press
ENTER.
3Use
/
to choose HDMI MODE then
press
ENTER
.
4Use
/
to choose the setting you want
then press
ENTER
.
AMP – Output audio sound of the DVD/CD
and USB function signal from this system.
TV – Output audio sound of the DVD/CD
and USB function signal from a TV or flat
screen TV.
2
Resetting the HDMI connection
If you get an error message (the display shows
HDMI ERR) or if the screen goes blank (for
example, after changing the resolution), check
the troubleshooting guide on page 58. If this
doesn’t solve the problem, follow the steps
below to reset the HDMI connection.
1 Press
SHIFT+SETUP
.
2Use
/
to select INITIAL then press
ENTER.
3Use
/
to choose HDMIINIT then press
ENTER
.
4 Press
ENTER
while INIT OK is blinking.
The system will restart and the HDMI settings
are automatically reset to the factory defaults.
See Video Output settings on page 38 for more
on these settings.
About HDMI
HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface)
supports both video and audio on a single
digital connection for use with DVD players,
DTV, set-top boxes, and other AV devices. HDMI
was developed to provide the technologies of
High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection
(HDCP) as well as Digital Visual Interface (DVI)
in one specification. HDCP is used to protect
digital content transmitted and received by
DVI-compliant displays.
Note
1 • An HDMI connection can only be made with DVI-equipped components compatible with both DVI and High Bandwidth
Digital Content Protection (HDCP). If you choose to connect to a DVI connector, you will need a separate adaptor (DVIHDMI)
to do so. A DVI connection, however, does not support audio signals. Consult your local audio dealer for more information.
• Depending on the component you have connected, using a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal transfers.
• When you change the component connected to the HDMI output, you will also need to change the HDMI settings to match
the new component (see Video Output settings on page 38 to do this).
2 This makes it possible to use the TV’s built-in speakers to listen to the audio input from a
DVD
and
USB
device. Audio output
from the HDMI terminal is 2 channel linear PCM only. In this event, no sound will be heard from this unit’s speakers (or
headphones). All other audio sources (including
TUNER
) are output from this unit normally.
12_Other connections.fm 44 ページ 2009年4月23日 木曜日 午後5時37分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections 12
45
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
HDMI has the capability to support standard,
enhanced, or high-definition video plus
standard to multichannel surround-sound
audio. HDMI features include uncompressed
digital video, a bandwidth of up to five
gigabytes per second (with HDTV signals), one
connector (instead of several cables and
connectors), and communication between the
AV source and AV devices such as DTVs.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition
Multimedia Interface are trademarks or
registered trademarks of HDMI licensing, LLC.
Connecting external antennas
For an external AM antenna, use 5 m to 6 m of
vinyl-insulated wire and set up either indoors or
outdoors. Leave the loop antenna connected.
Only use the included AM loop antenna.
For an external FM antenna, use a PAL
connector to hook up an external FM antenna.
For the connection diagram, see 6 on page 42.
Bluetooth
®
ADAPTER for
Wireless Enjoyment of Music
HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD-AP/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP models only:
Wireless music play
When the Bluetooth ADAPTER (Pioneer Model
No. AS-BT100) is connected to this unit, a
product equipped with Bluetooth wireless
technology (portable cell phone, digital music
player, etc.) can be used to listen to music
wirelessly.
1
Also, by using a commercially
available transmitter supporting Bluetooth
wireless technology, you can listen to music on
a device not equipped with Bluetooth wireless
technology. The AS-BT100 model supports
SCMS-T contents protection, so music can
also be enjoyed on devices equipped with
SCMS-T type Bluetooth wireless technology.
Remote control operation
The remote control supplied with this system
allows you to play and stop media, and perform
other operations.
2
Note
1 It may be necessary that the Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device supports A2DP profiles.
2 • It may be necessary that the Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device supports AVRCP profiles.
• Remote control operations cannot be guaranteed for all Bluetooth wireless technology enabled devices.
Music data
This unit
Bluetooth
®
ADAPTER
Remote control operation
Bluetooth
wireless
technology
enabled device:
cell phone
Bluetooth wireless
technology
enabled device:
Digital music
player
Device not
equipped with
Bluetooth wireless
technology:
Digital music
player
+
Bluetooth audio
transmitter
(sold commercially)
12_Other connections.fm 45 ページ 2009年4月23日 木曜日 午後5時37分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections12
46
En
Connecting Optional
Bluetooth
ADAPTER
1 Switch the system into standby and
connect
Bluetooth
ADAPTER to the
ADAPTER
PORT
located in the rear panel.
For the connection diagram, see 7 on page 42.
2Press
STANDBY/ON
.
3Press
ADAPTER PORT
and to switch to
BT
AUDIO
input mode.
1
Pairing
Bluetooth
ADAPTER and
Bluetooth
wireless technology
device
“Pairing” must be done before you start
playback of Bluetooth wireless technology
content using Bluetooth ADAPTER. Make sure
to perform pairing first time you operate the
system or any time pairing data is cleared.
“Pairing” is the step necessary to register
Bluetooth wireless technology device to enable
Bluetooth communications.
2
For more details,
see also the operating instructions of your
Bluetooth wireless technology device.
1Press
SHIFT+SETUP
to select
BT SETUP
,
then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to select
PAIRING
, then press
ENTER
.
3 Select the PIN code to be used from 0000/
1234/8888 using
/
, then press ENTER.
PAIRING blinks.
CAUTION
You can use any of 0000/1234/8888 PIN
codes. Bluetooth wireless technology
device using any other PIN code cannot be
used with this system.
4 Switch on the
Bluetooth
wireless
technology device that you want to make
pairing, place it near the system and set it
into the pairing mode.
5 Check to see that the
Bluetooth
ADAPTER
is detected by the
Bluetooth
wireless
technology device.
When the Bluetooth wireless technology
device detects the Bluetooth ADAPTER, the
adapter’s identification “AS-BT100” appears in
the Bluetooth wireless technology device list.
3
6From the
Bluetooth
wireless technology
device list, select
Bluetooth
ADAPTER and
enter the PIN code selected in the step 3.
4
Listening to Music Contents of
Bluetooth
wireless technology
device with Your System
1 Press
ADAPTER PORT
and to switch to
BT
AUDIO
input mode.
2 Connect the
Bluetooth
wireless
technology device to the
Bluetooth
ADAPTER.
Note
1 When the Bluetooth ADAPTER is not plugged in the ADAPTER PORT, BT AUDIO input mode cannot be entered even if
ADAPTER PORT is pressed.
2 • Pairing is required when you first use Bluetooth wireless technology device and Bluetooth ADAPTER.
• To enable Bluetooth communication, pairing should be done with both of your system and Bluetooth wireless technology
device.
3 When a Bluetooth wireless technology device does not appear in the list of detected devices or has no display, the Bluetooth
wireless technology device list does not appear. In some cases, you may pair the Bluetooth ADAPTER and that Bluetooth wireless
technology device by using the pairing mode.
4 PIN code may in some case be referred to as PASSKEY.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 46 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Other connections 12
47
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
When Bluetooth wireless technology device is
connected:
Bluetooth wireless technology device name
appears in the system display.
1
When Bluetooth wireless technology device is
not connected:
NODEVICE appears in the system display.
3 Start playback of music contents stored in
Bluetooth
wireless technology device.
The following operations are now possible for
Bluetooth wireless technology devices, using
the button at the top of the system and remote
controller.
2
Clearing Pairing
3
1Press
SHIFT+SETUP
, select
BT SETUP
,
then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
to select
PAIR CLR
, then press
ENTER
.
3 When
CLR OK
appears, press
ENTER
.
The Bluetooth
®
word mark and logos are
registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth
SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Pioneer
Corporation is under license. Other
trademarks and trade names are those of their
respective owners.
Note
1 The system can display alphanumeric characters only. Other characters may not be displayed correctly.
Button What it does
/
(system)
Starts normal playback and
pauses/unpauses playback.
(remote control)
Starts normal playback.
(remote control)
Pauses playback.
(system/
remote control)
Stops playback.
(remote control)
Press to start fast reverse
scanning.
(remote control)
Press to start fast forward
scanning.
(remote control)
Skips to the start of the
current file, then previous
files.
(remote control)
Skips to the next file.
2• Bluetooth wireless technology device should be compatible with AVRCP profile.
• Depending on Bluetooth wireless technology device you use, operation may differ from what is shown in this table.
3 • Clearing should be done with Bluetooth wireless technology device being disconnected.
• When you connect Bluetooth wireless technology device again after clearing, repeat the pairing steps referring to Pairing
Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth wireless technology device on page 46.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 47 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KURO LINK13
48
En
Chapter 13
KURO LINK
By connecting this unit to a KURO LINK-
compatible Pioneer flat screen TV with a HDMI
cable, you can control this unit from the
remote control of a connected flat screen TV,
as well as have the connected flat screen TV
automatically change inputs in response to
operations carried out on this unit.
In addition, when language information is
input from the connected flat screen TV, this
unit’s GUI display language automatically
changes (only when playback is stopped and
GUI screen is not displayed, with DVD/CD
function only).
Refer to the operating instructions for your flat
screen TV for more information about which
operations can be carried out by connecting
via HDMI cable.
You cannot use this function with
components that do not support KURO
LINK.
We cannot guarantee this unit will work
with KURO LINK-compatible components
other than those made by Pioneer.
Making the KURO LINK
connections
You can use synchronized operation for a
connected flat screen TV.
Be sure to connect the flat screen TV’s audio
cable to the audio input of this unit.
For the connection diagram, see 4 on page 42.
KURO LINK may not operate properly if you
do not use a High Speed HDMI cable.
Connect the flat screen TV directly to this
unit. Interrupting a direct connection with
other amps or an AV converter (such as an
HDMI switch) can cause operational
errors.
Important
When connecting this system or changing
connections, be sure to switch the power
off and disconnect the power cord from the
wall socket.
After completing all connections, connect
the power cords to the wall socket.
KURO LINK Setup
You must adjust the settings of this unit as well
as KURO LINK-compatible connected
components in order to make use of the KURO
LINK function. For more information see the
operating instructions for each component.
MAIN
USB
SUBMIC
PHONES
HDMI cable
HDMI cable
HDMI input
HDMI output
HDMI input
HDMI OUT
Other amps
or AV converter
This unit
KURO LINK-compatible
Pioneer flat screen TV
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 48 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KURO LINK 13
49
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Setting the KURO LINK mode
Choose whether to set this unit’s KURO LINK
function ON or OFF. You will need to set it to
LINK ON to use the KURO LINK function.
When using a TV that does not support the
KURO LINK function, set this to LINK OFF.
1 Press
SHIFT+SETUP
.
2Use
/
to select
HDMI SET
then press
ENTER
.
3 Use
/
to select
KURO LINK
, then
press
ENTER
.
4 Use
/
to select the setting then press
ENTER
to confirm.
LINK ON – Enables the KURO LINK
function.
LINK OFF – The KURO LINK is disabled.
Synchronized operations cannot be used.
Before using synchronization
Once you have finished all connections and
settings, you must:
1 Put all components into standby mode.
2 Turn the power ON for all components,
with the power for the flat screen TV being
turned on last.
3 Choose DVD/CD and see if video output
displays properly on the screen or not.
Synchronized amp mode
The synchronized amp mode can be set from
the KURO LINK-compatible TV’s remote
control. See the explanation below for
operations in the synchronized amp mode.
These functions are set from the TV’s menu
screen. For more information, refer to the
operating instructions of the KURO LINK-
compatible TV.
Synchronized amp mode operations
When using the synchronized amp mode, the
KURO LINK-compatible component
connected to this unit operates in sync as
described below.
The unit’s volume can be set and the sound
can be muted using the TV’s remote control.
When the TV’s power is set to standby, the
unit’s power is also set to standby. (The
unit’s power is automatically turned off
when the TV’s power is turned off while a
video DVD is being played on the unit.
However, the unit’s power may not turn off
automatically in some cases, for example,
if you are listening to a CD or radio and turn
off the output device.)
The unit’s input switches automatically
when the TV’s channel is switched.
The synchronized amp mode remains in
effect even if the unit’s input is switched to
a function other than the DVD/CD.
The operations below can also be used on
Pioneer KURO LINK-compatible flat screen
TVs.
When the unit’s volume is adjusted or the
sound is muted, the volume status is
displayed on the flat screen TV’s screen.
When the OSD language is switched on
the flat screen TV, the unit’s language
setting also switches accordingly.
Canceling synchronized amp mode
When the synchronized amp mode is
canceled, the unit’s power turns off if you
were viewing a TV program on the TV.
When in the synchronized amp mode, the
synchronized amp mode is canceled when
the unit’s power is turned off. To turn the
synchronized amp mode back on, select
the synchronized amp mode using the TV’s
remote control.
When in the synchronized amp mode, the
synchronized amp mode is canceled if an
operation that produces sound from the TV is
performed from the TV’s menu screen, etc.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 49 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
50
En
Chapter 14
Additional information
Optional system settings
See the notes in each section for more
information about the settings. The first setting
in each section is the default.
1 Press
SHIFT+SETUP
and use
/
to
select
SYS SET
then press
ENTER
.
2Use
/
then
ENTER
to choose the
setting you want to adjust.
The available settings are shown in the front
panel display.
1
3Use
/
to adjust then press
ENTER
to
confirm and exit.
Dimming the display
You can adjust the brightness of the text in the
front panel display.
LIGHT – Brighter setting
DARK – Darker setting
Key lock setting
LOCK ON – Makes the front panel buttons
and controls inoperative.
LOCK OFF – Restores regular use of the
front panel buttons and controls.
Frequency step setting
Not applicable to Saudi Arabia, Israel, South
Africa, other middle eastern contries and duty
free models
If you find that you can’t tune into stations
successfully, the frequency step may not be
suitable for your country/region.
•AM 9K
•AM 10K
TV system setting
The default setting of this system is AUTO, and
unless you notice that the picture is distorted
when playing some discs, you should leave it
set to AUTO. If you find picture distortion with
some discs, set the TV system to match your
country or region’s system. However, this may
restrict the kinds of disc you can watch. See
the table for the kinds of discs compatible with
each setting (AUTO, PAL and NTSC).
2
After using
/
to choose
TV SYS
(step
3
above), press
ENTER
to change the TV
system as follows:
AUTO NTSC
NTSC PAL
PAL AUTO
Press ENTER while CHANGE is blinking.
The system will automatically enter standby
mode, then turn on again. You’ll see the new TV
system setting in the display after seeing
POWER ON.
Note
1 The setup menu is exited automatically after 5 minutes of inactivity.
2 Most models of the newly developed countdown PAL TV system detect 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz (NTSC) and automatically switch
vertical amplitude, resulting in a display without vertical shrinkage. However, in some cases, the image may appear without
color. If your PAL TV does not have a V-Hold control, you may not be able to watch NTSC discs because of picture roll. If the TV
has a V-Hold control, adjust it until the picture stops rolling. On some TVs, the picture may shrink vertically, leaving black bands
at the top and bottom of the screen.
Player setting
Media Type
Format NTSC PAL AUTO
DVD/Super VCD/
Video CD/DivX
Video/WMV
NTSC
NTSC PAL NTSC
PAL
NTSC PAL PAL
CD/MP3/WMV/
MPEG-4 AAC/
JPEG/no disc
NTSC PAL NTSC or
PAL
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 50 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
51
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Setting the sleep timer
The sleep timer switches off the system after
about an hour so you can fall asleep without
worrying about it.
1
•Press
SHIFT+SLEEP
repeatedly to select
an option.
Choose between the following options:
SLP ON – Switches off after about an hour.
The indicator lights.
SLP OFF – Cancels the sleep timer.
After selecting SLP ON, you can press
SHIFT+SLEEP again to check how much time is
left. Each line indicates approximately 12
minutes (remaining):
Disc/content format playback
compatibility
This player is compatible with a wide range of
disc types (media) and formats. Playable discs
will generally feature one of the following logos
on the disc and/or disc packaging. Note however
that some disc types, such as recordable CD and
DVD, may be in an unplayable format.
See the Disc compatibility table below for more
information.
This unit will play DVD+R/+RW discs.
is a trademark of FUJIFILM
Corporation.
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
Also compatible with KODAK Picture CD.
This player supports the IEC’s Super VCD
standard for superior picture quality, dual
soundtracks, and widescreen support.
About DualDisc playback
A DualDisc is a new two -sided disc, one side
of which contains DVD content video, audio,
etc. while the other side contains non-DVD
content such as digital audio material.
The non-DVD, audio side of the disc is not
compliant with the CD Audio specification
and therefore may not play.
The DVD side of a DualDisc plays in this
product. DVD-Audio content will not play.
For more detailed information on the
DualDisc specification, please refer to the
disc manufacturer or disc retailer.
Disc compatibility table
Note
1 The display dims when the sleep timer is set.
SLP --- --
DVD-Video DVD-R DVD-RW
Video CD
Fujicolor CD
Audio CD CD-R CD-RW
Media Compatible formats
CD-R/-RW
• CD-Audio, Video CD/Super VCD, ISO
9660 CD-ROM* containing MP3, WMA,
MPEG-4 AAC, JPEG or DivX video/WMV
files.
* ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. CD
physical format: Mode1, Mode2 XA
Form1. Romeo and Joliet file systems
are both compatible.
• Multi-session playback: No
• Unfinalized disc playback: No
Super Video CD (Super VCD)
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 51 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
52
En
About DVD+R/DVD+RW compatibility
Only DVD+R/DVD+RW discs recorded in
‘Video Mode (DVD Video Mode)’ which have
been finalized, can be played back. However,
some editing made during the recording may
not be played back accurately.
About DivX
DivX is a digital video format created by DivX,
Inc. This player can play DivX videos recorded
on DVDs, CDs, or USB storage devices.
Keeping the same terminology as DVD-Video,
individual DivX video files are called “Titles”.
DivX video compatibility
Plays DivX
®
video
1
File extensions: .avi and .divx (these must be
used for the player to recognize DivX video
files). Note that all files with the .avi
extension are recognized as MPEG4, but not
all of these are necessarily DivX video files
and therefore may not be playable on this
player.
DVD-R/-RW
• DVD-Video (Video mode), Video
Recording (VR)*, UDF Bridge DVD-ROM
containing MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC,
JPEG or DivX video/WMV files.
* Edit points may not play exactly as
edited; screen may go momentarily
blank at edited points.
• Multi Border playback: No
• Unfinalized playback: No
PC-created
disc
• Discs recorded using a PC may not
be playable due to the setting of the
software used to create the disc. In
these instances, check the DVD-R/
-RW or CD-R/-RW software manual or
disc boxes for more on compatibility.
• Discs recorded in packet write mode
are not compatible.
Compressed
audio
• MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3),
Windows Media Audio (WMA), MPEG-
4 AAC
• Sampling rates: 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/
48 kHz
• Bit-rates: Any (128 kbps or higher
recommended)
• VBR (variable bit rate) MP3/WMA/
MPEG-4 AAC playback: No
• WMA lossless encoding: No
• DRM (Digital Rights Management)
compatible: Yes (DRM-protected audio
files will not play in this player.)
• File extensions: .mp3, .wma, .m4a
(these must be used for the player to
recognize MP3/WMA/MPEG-4 AAC files)
• File structure (may differ): Up to 299
folders on a disc; up to 648 folders and
files (combined) within each folder
Media Compatible formats
JPEG file
• Baseline JPEG and EXIF 2.2* still
image files up to a resolution of
3072 x 2048
*File format for digital still cameras
• Progressive JPEG compatible: No
• File extensions: .jpg (must be used
for the player to recognize JPEG files)
• File structure (may differ): Up to 299
folders on a disc; up to 648 folders and
files (combined) within each folder
Note
1 Playback of .avi video files larger than 4 GB is not possible.
Media Compatible formats
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 52 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
53
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Displaying DivX subtitle files
The font sets listed below are available for DivX
external subtitle files. You can see the proper
font set on-screen by setting the Subtitle
Language (in Language settings on page 39)
to match the subtitle file.
1
Group 1: Albanian (sq), Basque (eu), Catalan (ca),
Danish (da), Dutch (nl), English (en), Faroese (fo),
Finnish (fi), French (fr), German (de), Icelandic (is),
Irish (ga), Italian (it), Norwegian (no), Portuguese (pt),
Rhaeto-Romanic (rm), Scottish (gd), Spanish (es),
Swedish (sv)
Group 2: Albanian (sq), Croatian (hr), Czech (cs),
Hungarian (hu), Polish (pl), Romanian (ro), Slovak (sk),
Slovenian (sl)
Group 3: Bulgarian (bg), Byelorussian (be),
Macedonian (mk), Russian (ru), Serbian (sr),
Ukrainian (uk)
Group 4: Hebrew (iw), Yiddish (ji)
Group 5: Turkish (tr)
DivX
®
is registered trademarks of DivX, Inc. and
is used under license.
About WMV
WMV is an acronym for Windows Media Video
and refers to a video compression technology
developed by Microsoft Corporation. WMV
content can be encoded by using Windows
Media Encoder.
This player is compatible with WMV9 files
that are encoded by using the Windows
Media Encoder 9 Series, with .wmv as an
extension.
Compatible with size under 720 x 576 pixels/
720 x 480 pixels.
Advanced Profile is not supported.
DRM-protected video files will not play in
this player.
File extensions .wmv.
Compatible with bit rate under 192 kbps.
About MPEG-4 AAC
Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) is at the core of
the MPEG-4 AAC standard, which incorporates
MPEG-2 AAC, forming the basis of the MPEG-4
audio compression technology. The file format
and extension used depend on the application
used to encode the AAC file. This unit plays
back AAC files encoded by iTunes
®
bearing
the extension ‘.m4a’. DRM-protected files will
not play, and files encoded with some versions
of iTunes
®
may not play, or filenames may
display incorrectly.
Apple and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
About WMA
This player can playback Windows Media
Audio content.
WMA is an acronym for Windows Media Audio
and refers to an audio compression technology
developed by Microsoft Corporation. WMA
content can be encoded by using Windows
Media
Player version 7.7.1, Windows Media
Player for Windows XP, or Windows Media
Player 9 series.
Windows Media is a trademark of Microsoft
Corporation.
This product includes technology owned by
Microsoft Corporation and cannot be used or
distributed without a license from Microsoft
Licensing, Inc.
Note
1 • For external subtitle files the following subtitle format filename extensions are supported (please note that these files are not
shown within the disc navigation menu): .srt, .sub, .ssa, .smi
• Some external subtitle files may be displayed incorrectly or not at all.
• The filename of the movie file has to be repeated at the beginning of the filename for the external subtitle file.
• The number of external subtitle files which can be switched for the same movie file is limited to a maximum of 10.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 53 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
54
En
Using and taking care of discs
Handling discs
Hold the disc by its edges when handling so as
not to leave fingerprints, dirt or scratches on
either side of the disc. Damaged or dirty discs
can affect playback performance.
If a disc becomes marked with fingerprints,
dust, etc., clean using a soft, dry cloth.
Wipe lightly from the center of the disc using
straight strokes. Don’t wipe the disc surface
with circular strokes.
If necessary, use a cloth soaked in alcohol, or a
commercially available CD/DVD cleaning kit to
clean a disc more thoroughly. Never use
benzine, thinner or other cleaning agents such
as those designed for cleaning vinyl records.
Storing discs
Avoid leaving discs in excessively cold, humid,
or hot environments (including under direct
sunlight). Don’t glue paper or put stickers onto
the disc, or use a pencil, ball-point pen or other
sharp-tipped writing instrument. These could
all damage the disc.
Discs to avoid
Discs spin at high speed inside the player. If a
disc is cracked, chipped, warped, or otherwise
damaged, don’t risk using it in your player—
you could end up damaging the unit.
This unit is designed for use with conventional,
fully circular discs only. Pioneer disclaims all
liability arising in connection with the use of
shaped discs.
DVD Video regions
All DVD Video discs carry a region mark that
indicates which region(s) of the world the disc
is compatible with. Your DVD system also has
a region mark (on the rear panel). Discs from
incompatible regions will not play in this
player. In this instance, the following message
appears on-screen:
Incompatible disc region number
Can’t play disc
Discs marked ALL play in any player.
Installation and maintenance
Hints on installation
We want you to enjoy using this system for
years to come, so please bear in mind the
following points when choosing a location:
Do...
Use in a well-ventilated room.
Place on a solid, flat, level surface, such as a
table, shelf or stereo rack.
Don’t...
Use in a place exposed to high temperatures or
humidity, including near radiators and other
heat-generating appliances.
Place on a window sill or other place where the
system will be exposed to direct sunlight.
Use in an excessively dusty or damp
environment.
Place directly on top of an amplifier, or other
component in your stereo system that becomes
hot in use.
Use near a television or monitor as you may
experience interference — especially if the
television uses an indoor antenna.
Use in a kitchen or other room where the system
may be exposed to smoke or steam.
Use on a thick rug or carpet, or cover with cloth
— this may prevent proper cooling of the system
unit.
Place on an unstable surface, or one that is not
large enough to support all four of the system
unit’s feet.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 54 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
55
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Cleaning the pickup lens
The DVD player’s lens should not become dirty
in normal use, but if for some reason it should
malfunction due to dust or dirt, consult your
nearest Pioneer authorized service center.
Although lens cleaners are commercially
available, we do not recommend using them
since some may damage the lens.
Problems with condensation
Condensation may form inside the player if it is
brought into a warm room from outside, or if
the temperature of the room rises quickly.
Although the condensation won’t damage the
player, it may temporarily impair performance.
Leave it to adjust to the warmer temperature
for about an hour before switching on.
Moving the system unit
If you need to move the main unit, first remove
a disc if there’s one in the player, then press
STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn the
system off. Wait for -OFF- to disappear from
the display, then unplug the power cord.
1
Never lift or move the unit during playback —
discs rotate at high speeds and may damage.
Screen sizes and disc formats
DVD-Video discs come in different screen
aspects, ranging from TV programs, which are
generally 4:3, to CinemaScope widescreen
movies
2
, with an aspect ratio of up to about 7:3.
Televisions also come in different aspect ratios;
‘standard’ 4:3 and widescreen 16:9.
3
Widescreen TV users
If you have a widescreen TV, the TV Screen
setting (page 40) of this player should be set
to 16:9 (Wide) or 16:9 (Compressed).
When you watch discs recorded in 4:3 format
with the 16:9 (Wide) setting, you can use the
TV controls to select how the picture is
presented. Your TV may offer various zoom and
stretch options; see the instructions that came
with your TV for details.
Please note that some movie aspect ratios are
wider than 16:9, so even though you have a
widescreen TV, these discs will still play in a
‘letter box’ style with black bars at the top and
bottom of the screen.
Standard TV users
If you have a standard TV, the TV Screen
setting (page 38) of this player should be
set to 4:3 (Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan),
depending on which you prefer.
Please note that many widescreen discs
override the player’s setting so that the disc
is shown in letter box format regardless of the
setting.
Note
1 Unplugging the unit before -OFF- disappears from the display may cause the system to return to the factory settings.
2 Many widescreen discs override the system’s settings so that the disc is shown in letterbox format regardless of the setting.
3Using the 16:9 (Wide) or 16:9 (Compressed) setting with a standard 4:3 TV, or one of the 4:3 settings with a widescreen TV,
will result in picture distortion.
Set to 4:3 (Letter Box), widescreen
discs are shown with black bars top
and bottom.
Set to 4:3 (Pan & Scan), widescreen
discs are shown with the left and
right sides cropped. Although the
picture looks larger, you don’t
actually see the whole picture.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 55 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
56
En
Troubleshooting
Incorrect operations are often mistaken for trouble and malfunctions. If you think that there is
something wrong with this component, check the points below. Sometimes the trouble may lie in
another component. Investigate the other components and electrical appliances being used. If the
trouble cannot be rectified even after exercising the checks listed below, ask your nearest Pioneer
authorized service center or your dealer to carry out repair work.
If the system does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity,
disconnect the plug from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating conditions.
For audio-related problems, please also check the settings of the audio playback device. See
the operating instructions for the device for detailed information.
General
Problem Remedy
The power does not turn
on, or switches off
suddenly (an error
message may be
displayed at startup).
• Wait for one minute before switching back on.
• Make sure there are no loose strands of wire touching the unit. This could cause
the system to shut off automatically.
• Check that the speakers are connected correctly.
• Make sure the voltage of the mains power source is correct for the model.
• Try reducing the volume level.
• If the problem persists, take it to your nearest Pioneer authorized service center
or your dealer for servicing.
No sound is output
when a function is
selected.
• If you’re using the line input, make sure the component is connected correctly
(see Connecting using the component video output on page 43).
• No audio is output from the speakers connected to this unit if HDMI audio mode
is set to TV (page 44).
• Press MUTE on the remote control to turn muting off.
• Turn up the volume.
No sound from surround
or center speakers.
• Refer to Channel level setting (CH LEVEL) on page 35 to check the speaker levels.
• Check that you haven’t selected the STEREO or A.L.C mode (see Listening to your
system on page 22).
• Connect the speakers properly (see Basic connections on page 11).
• If the source is 96 kHz, it will be played in stereo.
• Confirm audio output settings for the external component connected by optical
digital cable.
Can’t operate the remote
control.
• Replace the batteries (see Putting the batteries in the remote control on page 16).
• Operate within
7
m,
30°
of the remote sensor (see
Using the remote control
on page 16).
• Remove any obstacles or operate from another position.
• Avoid exposing the remote sensor on the front panel to direct light.
The microphone can’t be
heard.
• You are only using one microphone and it’s plugged into the MIC (SUB) jack. The
MIC (SUB) jack can only be used if there is also a microphone plugged into the MIC
(MAIN) jack.
• Adjust the MIC VOL +/–.
Feedback noise when
mic is switched on.
• The mic is pointing toward the speakers. Keep the mic pointed away from the speakers.
• The microphone level is set too high. Turn down the mic control level.
TRAYLOCK shows in the
display and the tray can’t
be ejected.
• Press and hold OPEN/CLOSE on the front panel for about eight seconds. Then
the tray can be opened/closed using OPEN/CLOSE.
2D or DTS does not
light when playing
Dolby/DTS software.
* HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-
FS30DVD-AP only
• If Dolby Digital Out settings is set to PCM, speaker audio output are converted
to PCM. Make sure that the player is set to Dolby Digital or DTS (see Digital Audio
Out settings on page 38).
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 56 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
57
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
DVD/CD/Video CD player
Problem Remedy
The disc is ejected
automatically after
loading.
• Clean the disc and align the disc properly in the disc guide.
• If the region number on a DVD-video disc does not match the number on the
player, the disc cannot be used (see DVD Video regions on page 54). In this
instance, the following message appears on screen: Incompatible disc region
number/Can’t play disc.
• Allow time for any condensation inside the player to evaporate. Avoid using the
player near an air-conditioning unit.
Playback not possible. • If the disc is loaded upside down, reload the disc with label side face up.
Picture playback stops
and buttons cannot be
used.
• Press (stop), then (play) to start playback again.
• Switch the power off once, then on again using the front panel
STANDBY/ON button.
Settings are canceled. • When the power is cut, settings will be canceled.
No picture/No color. Check that connections are correct and that plugs are inserted fully.
• Check the manual of the TV/monitor to make sure the settings are correct.
• If the Progressive setting is selected and you have used component video cables
to connect a TV that is not compatible with a progressive scan signal, you will not
be able to see any picture at all. With your TV connected using either the
composite or S-video terminals, change the Component Out setting to Interlace
(see Video Output settings on page 38).
Screen is stretched or
aspect doesn’t change.
• The TV Screen setting is incorrect. Set the TV Screen option to match the TV/
monitor you’re using (see Video Output settings on page 38).
When recorded on a
VCR or passed through
an AV selector, there is
disturbance in the
playback picture.
• This system uses copy-protection technology which may prevent recording or
cause picture problems when connected through a VCR or AV selector. This is not
a malfunction.
Picture disturbance
during playback or dark.
• This player is compatible with Macro-Vision System copy guard. Some discs include
a copy prevention signal, and when this type of disc is played back, stripes etc., may
appear on some sections of the picture depending on the TV. This is not a malfunction.
• Discs respond differently to particular player functions. This may result in the
screen becoming black for a brief instant or shaking slightly when the function is
executed. These problems are largely due to differences between discs and disc
content and are not malfunctions of this player.
Noticeable difference in
DVD and CD volume.
• DVDs and CDs use different recording methods. This is not a malfunction.
CD-ROM disc is not
recognized.
• Make sure that the CD-ROM was recorded using the ISO 9660 disc format. See
Disc compatibility table on page 51 for more on disc compatibility.
DVD-ROM disc is not
recognized.
• Make sure that the DVD-ROM was recorded using the UDF bridge format. See
Disc compatibility table on page 51 for more on disc compatibility.
Files don’t show up in
the Disc Navigator/
Photo Browser.
• The files on the disc must be named with the correct file extension: .mp3 for MP3
files; .wma for WMA files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC files; .jpg for JPEG files (upper or
lower-case is OK). See Disc compatibility table on page 51.
Can’t play WMA or
MPEG-4 AAC files.
• The files were recorded using DRM (digital rights management). This is not a
malfunction.
Can’t play WMV files. • When the bit rate the file is more than 192 kbps, the file cannot be played back.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 57 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
58
En
Tuner
USB connection
HDMI connection
Problem Remedy
Considerable noise in
radio broadcasts.
• Connect the AM antenna (refer to Basic connections on page 11) and adjust the
direction and position for best reception. You may also connect an additional
internal or external AM antenna (refer to Connecting external antennas on page 45).
• Fully extend the FM wire antenna, position for best reception, and secure to a
wall. You may also connect an outdoor FM antenna (see Connecting external
antennas on page 45).
• Turn off other equipment that may be causing the noise or move it further away.
The tuning interval is incorrect for your country or region. See Frequency
step setting
on page 50 to switch the tuning interval.
Auto tuning does not
pick up some stations.
• The radio signal is weak. Auto tuning will only detect radio stations with a good
signal. For more sensitive tuning, connect an outdoor antenna.
Problem Remedy
USB mass storage
device is not recognized
by the system.
• Make sure you have completely inserted the USB connector to this unit.
• Check that the memory format is FAT16 or FAT32.
• USB devices with an internal USB hub are not supported.
Files don’t show up in
the Navigator/Photo
Browser.
• The files must have the correct file extension: .mp3 for MP3 files; .wma for WMA
files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC files; .jpg for JPEG files (upper or lower-case is OK).
• Make sure the file permission hasn’t been restricted (through a password, etc.).
Can’t play WMA or
MPEG-4 AAC files.
• The files were recorded using DRM (digital rights management). This is not a
malfunction.
Problem Remedy
No HDMI video output. • Make sure that you’ve selected this player as the HDMI input in the settings for
the component you’re using (refer to the component’s instruction manual).
• Check that the HDMI cable is connected properly and isn’t damaged.
• Check that components connected using the HDMI interface are switched on
and HDMI compatible (components must be compatible with both DVI and High
Bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP)).
• Depending on the component you have connected, using a DVI connection may
result in unreliable signal transfers.
• Make sure the resolution on this player matches that of the component you have
connected using HDMI. See Video Output settings on page 38 to change the HDMI
resolution.
• If the screen goes blank after changing the resolution, it means the resolution
you selected is incompatible with your monitor. See Resetting the HDMI
connection on page 44 to reset to the factory defaults.
Color problems occur
with your monitor after
changing the
HDMI
Color
setting (page 39).
• Depending on the connected equipment, some HDMI Color settings may cause
the picture to be displayed incorrectly. In this case, use the TV’s own video input
settings to select RGB, if possible. Alternatively, revert to the previous HDMI Color
setting.
No picture or sound. • If the problem still persists when connecting your HDMI component directly to
your monitor, please consult the component or monitor manual or contact the
manufacturer for support.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 58 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
59
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Bluetooth connection
Error Messages
No HDMI audio output
• See
Switching the HDMI audio setting
on page 44 to make sure that
TV
is selected.
KURO LINK does not
function.
• Verify that the HDMI cable is firmly connected.
• Make sure that this unit’s KURO LINK mode is set to LINK ON (page 48).
• Check whether the connected component supports KURO LINK or not. For more
information refer to the operating manual of your flat screen TV.
• KURO LINK may not work properly if a SCART cable and an HDMI cable are
connected simultaneously. Set KURO LINK mode to LINK OFF when connecting
SCART and HDMI cables simultaneously.
Your TV automatically
change inputs.
• The connected TV automatically may change inputs in response to this unit
starting playback DVD or having the GUI screen (ex. Disc Navigator) displayed, etc.
If you do not want your TV to change inputs in this way, set this unit KURO LINK
mode to LINK OFF (page 48).
Problem Remedy
Problem Remedy
The Bluetooth wireless
technology device
cannot be connected or
operated. Sound from
the Bluetooth wireless
technology device is not
emitted or the sound is
interrupted.
• Check that no object that emits electromagnetic waves in the 2.4 GHz band
(microwave oven, wireless LAN device or Bluetooth wireless technology apparatus)
is near the unit. If such an object is near the unit, set the unit far from it. Or, stop
using the object emitting the electromagnetic waves.
• Check that the
Bluetooth
wireless technology device is not too far from the unit and
that obstructions are not set between the
Bluetooth
wireless technology device and the
unit. Set the
Bluetooth
wireless technology device and the unit so that the distance
between them is less than about 10 m and no obstructions exist between them.
• Check that the Bluetooth ADAPTER and the ADAPTER PORT of the unit are
correctly connected.
• The Bluetooth wireless technology device may not be set to the communication
mode supporting the Bluetooth wireless technology. Check the setting of the
Bluetooth wireless technology device.
• Check that pairing is correct. The pairing setting was deleted from this unit or the
Bluetooth wireless technology device. Reset the pairing.
• Check that the profile is correct. Use a Bluetooth wireless technology device that
supports A2DP profile and AVRCP profile.
Message Description
2CH ONLY • An operation is prohibited because it is only applicable to 2 channel sources,
while the current source is a multichannel source.
96K • An operation is prohibited because the source is 96 kHz digital.
NOISY • Background noise is too high to complete MCACC setup successfully.
ERR MIC • An error occured during MCACC setup because the microphone is not
connected or is not connected properly.
ERR SP • An error occured during MCACC setup because the speakers are not connected
or are not connected properly.
MUTING An operation is prohibited because the sound is muted (press MUTE).
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 59 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
60
En
Resetting the system
Use the front panel controls to reset all system
settings to the factory default.
1
With the system on,
press
SHIFT+SETUP
.
2Use
/
to select INITIAL then press
ENTER.
3Use
/
to select ALL INIT then press
ENTER
.
INIT OK is displayed.
4Press
ENTER
while INIT OK is blinking.
1
Using the language code list
Some of the language options (see Language
settings on page 39) allow you to set your
preferred language from any of the 136
languages in the Language code list below.
1 Select ‘Other Language’.
2Use
/
to select either a code letter or
a code number.
3Use
/
to select a code letter or a code
number.
See the Language code list below for a
complete list of languages and codes.
NO MIC
• Appears when you press SHIFT+KARAOKE, SHIFT+ECHO, SHIFT+, SHIFT+or
MIC VOL +/– when no mic is inserted.
OC ERR 1
OC ERR 2
• Check whether the speaker cables are short-circuited. If the error message
continues to be displayed, contact your Pioneer authorized service center or your
dealer for servicing.
OVER TEMP • Try lowering the volume. If this problem is not fixed by removing and inserting
the power cable, this unit may be damaged. In such an event, please contact a
Pioneer-authorized service center or your nearest dealer.
BT ERR • Power consumption by Bluetooth ADAPTER is too high to supply the power.
Reconnect the Bluetooth ADAPTER.
TV AUDIO • Indicator is lit for two seconds if the listening mode is changed while HDMI
audio mode is set for TV.
CANNOT Operation is prohibited because DVD/CD or USB isn’t selected.
• Appears when DVD/CD is not selected and SHIFT+USB REC is pressed.
KARAOKE Appears when you press SURROUND, SOUND, AUTO/STEREO, SOUND
RETRIEVER or SHIFT+MCACC (
HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP only
)
when a mic is inserted.
TRAYLOCK • The tray lock is on. See General in Troubleshooting on page 56.
KEYLOCK • The key lock is enabled. See Setting the sleep timer on page 51.
PHONESIN • An operation is prohibited because the headphones are connected.
HDMI ERR • See HDMI connection above for troubleshooting tips. See also Resetting the
HDMI connection on page 44 if the problem persists.
USB ERR • See Important in Using the USB interface on page 32 for more on this.
EEP ERR • Contact your Pioneer authorized service center or your dealer for servicing.
EXIT • Appears when any prohibited signal is input or the headphones are connected
while the menu screen is displayed, and then the display returns to the normal
display.
Message Description
Note
1 Do not operate the unit without reason or pull the power cord because the system’s power automatically turns on.
14_Additional_information.fm 60 ページ 2009年4月16日 木曜日 午前11時20分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
61
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Language code list
Language (Language code letter), Language code
Country/Area code list
Country/Area, Country/Area code, Country/Area code letter
Japanese (ja), 1001
English (en), 0514
French (fr), 0618
German (de), 0405
Italian (it), 0920
Spanish (es), 0519
Dutch (nl), 1412
Russian (ru), 1821
Chinese (zh), 2608
Korean (ko), 1115
Greek (el), 0512
Afar (aa), 0101
Abkhazian (ab), 0102
Afrikaans (af), 0106
Amharic (am), 0113
Arabic (ar), 0118
Assamese (as), 0119
Aymara (ay), 0125
Azerbaijani (az), 0126
Bashkir (ba), 0201
Byelorussian (be), 0205
Bulgarian (bg), 0207
Bihari (bh), 0208
Bislama (bi), 0209
Bengali (bn), 0214
Tibetan (bo), 0215
Breton (br), 0218
Catalan (ca), 0301
Corsican (co), 0315
Czech (cs), 0319
Welsh (cy), 0325
Danish (da), 0401
Bhutani (dz), 0426
Esperanto (eo), 0515
Estonian (et), 0520
Basque (eu), 0521
Persian (fa), 0601
Finnish (fi), 0609
Fiji (fj), 0610
Faroese (fo), 0615
Frisian (fy), 0625
Irish (ga), 0701
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704
Galician (gl), 0712
Guarani (gn), 0714
Gujarati (gu), 0721
Hausa (ha), 0801
Hindi (hi), 0809
Croatian (hr), 0818
Hungarian (hu), 0821
Armenian (hy), 0825
Interlingua (ia), 0901
Interlingue (ie), 0905
Inupiak (ik), 0911
Indonesian (in), 0914
Icelandic (is), 0919
Hebrew (iw), 0923
Yiddish (ji), 1009
Javanese (jw), 1023
Georgian (ka), 1101
Kazakh (kk), 1111
Greenlandic (kl), 1112
Cambodian (km), 1113
Kannada (kn), 1114
Kashmiri (ks), 1119
Kurdish (ku), 1121
Kirghiz (ky), 1125
Latin (la), 1201
Lingala (ln), 1214
Laothian (lo), 1215
Lithuanian (lt), 1220
Latvian (lv), 1222
Malagasy (mg), 1307
Maori (mi), 1309
Macedonian (mk), 1311
Malayalam (ml), 1312
Mongolian (mn), 1314
Moldavian (mo), 1315
Marathi (mr), 1318
Malay (ms), 1319
Maltese (mt), 1320
Burmese (my), 1325
Nauru (na), 1401
Nepali (ne), 1405
Norwegian (no), 1415
Oc
citan
(oc), 1503
Oromo (om), 1513
Oriya (or), 1518
Panjabi (pa), 1601
Polish (pl), 1612
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619
Portuguese (pt), 1620
Quechua (qu), 1721
Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813
Kirundi (rn), 1814
Romanian (ro), 1815
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823
Sanskrit (sa), 1901
Sindhi (sd), 1904
Sangho (sg), 1907
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908
Sinhalese (si), 1909
Slovak (sk), 1911
Slovenian (sl), 1912
Samoan (sm), 1913
Shona (sn), 1914
Somali (so), 1915
Albanian (sq), 1917
Serbian (sr), 1918
Siswati (ss), 1919
Sesotho (st), 1920
Sundanese (su), 1921
Swedish (sv), 1922
Swahili (sw), 1923
Tamil (ta), 2001
Telugu (te), 2005
Tajik (tg), 2007
Thai (th), 2008
Tigrinya (ti), 2009
Turkmen (tk), 2011
Tagalog (tl), 2012
Setswana (tn), 2014
Tonga (to), 2015
Turkish (tr), 2018
Tsonga (ts), 2019
Tatar (tt), 2020
Twi (tw), 2023
Ukrainian (uk), 2111
Urdu (ur), 2118
Uzbek (uz), 2126
Vietnamese (vi), 2209
Volapük (vo), 2215
Wolof (wo), 2315
Xhosa (xh), 2408
Yoruba (yo), 2515
Zulu (zu), 26
21
Argentina, 01
18, ar
Australia, 0121, au
Austria, 0120, at
Belgium, 0205, be
Brazil, 0218, br
Canada, 0301, ca
Chile, 0312, cl
China, 0314, cn
Denmark, 0411, dk
Finland, 0609, fi
France, 0618, fr
Germany, 0405, de
Hong Kong, 0811, hk
India, 0914, in
Indonesia, 0904, id
Italy, 0920, it
Japan, 1016, jp
Korea, Republic of, 1118, kr
Malaysia, 1325, my
Mexico, 1324, mx
Netherlands, 1412, nl
New Zealand, 1426, nz
Norway, 1415, no
Pakistan, 1611, pk
Philippines, 1608, ph
Portugal, 1620, pt
Russian Federation, 1821, ru
Singapore, 1907, sg
Spain, 0519, es
Switzerland, 0308, ch
Sweden, 1905, se
Taiwan, 2023, tw
Thailand, 2008, th
United Kingdom, 0702, gb
United States of America, 2119, us
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 61 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information14
62
En
Specifications
Amplifier section
RMS Power Output:
Front, Center, Surround . . 100 W per channel
(1 kHz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 Ω)
Subwoofer
. . . . 100 W (100 Hz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 Ω)
Disc section
Type . . . . . DVD system, Video CD/Super VCD
system and Compact Disc digital audio system
FM tuner section
Frequency range . . . . . . 87.5 MHz to 108 MHz
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Ω, unbalanced
AM tuner section
Frequency range:
Saudi Arabia, Israel, South Africa, other middle
eastern contries and duty free models
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz
All other models
With 9 kHz step . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz
With 10 kHz step . . . . 530 kHz to 1700 kHz
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Loop antenna
Miscellaneous
Power requirements:
Singapore, Indonesia, Hong Kong, Malaysia,
Philippines models
. . . . . . . . . . AC 220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz
All other models
. . . . . . . . . . AC 110 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz
Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 W
Power consumption in standby:
KURO LINK ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0.73 W
KURO LINK OFF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0.48 W
Dimensions
. . . . . 420 mm (W) x 62 mm (H) x 331 mm (D)
Weight:
For XV-DV585AP/787AP/787 . . . . . . . 2.9 kg
For XV-DV30FS/30FSAP. . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 kg
Accessories (DVD/CD receiver)
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
AA/R6 dry cell batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
(to confirm system operation)
Video cable (yellow plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
FM antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Microphone (for Auto MCACC setup)
1
. . . . . 1
Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Setup Guide
Operating instructions (This document)
S-DV585 Speaker system
Front/surround speakers
Enclosure. . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type
(magnetically shielded)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system
Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz
Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
Dimensions
. . . . . . . .96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg
Center speaker
Enclosure . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type
(magnetically shielded)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system
Speakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz
Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 W
Dimensions
. . . . . . . .96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg
•Subwoofer
Enclosure . . . . .Bass-reflex floorstanding type
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system
Speaker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz to 1 kHz
Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
Dimensions
. . . . .230 mm (W) x 380 mm (H) x 360 mm (D)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg
Accessories
Speaker cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Mounting brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Screws (common use for brackets and
mounting brackets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
S-DV787T Speaker system
Front/surround speakers
Enclosure . . . . .Closed-box floorstanding type
(magnetically shielded)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-way system
Speakers:
Woofer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type
Tweeter . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm semi-dome type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz to 20 kHz
Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
Dimensions
. . . .260 mm (W) x 1097 mm (H) x 260 mm (D)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg
Center speaker
Enclosure . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type
(magnetically shielded)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system
Speakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz to 20 kHz
Note
1 For HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP model only.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 62 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Additional information 14
63
En
English
FrançaisDeutsch
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
Dimensions
. . . . . 220 mm (W) x 90 mm (H) x 100 mm (D)
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg
Accessories
Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Screws (for bases). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
S-DV5SW Speaker system
•Subwoofer
Same as S-DV585 Subwoofer (see above)
Accessories
Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
S-DV30FS Speaker system
Front speakers
Enclosure . . . . . Closed-box floorstanding type
(magnetically shielded)
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-way system
Speakers:
Woofer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 cm cone type x2
Tweeter . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm semi-dome type
Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Ω
Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 200 Hz to 20 kHz
Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
Dimensions:
Without speaker stand
. . . . . . .77 mm (W) x 395 mm (H) x 55 mm (D)
With speaker stand
. . . .150 mm (W) x 414 mm (H)
1
x 150 mm (D)
Weight:
Without speaker stand. . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.0 kg
With speaker stand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 kg
•Subwoofer
Same as S-DV585 Subwoofer (see above)
2
Accessories
Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Poles (with circular nuts) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Metal catches (For front side) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Metal catches (For rear side) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Screws . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Hexagon nuts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Spanner… . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Note
Specifications and design subject to
possible modification without notice, due
to improvements.
Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”
, and the
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
For HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent
#’s: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762;
6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents
issued & pending. DTS and DTS Digital Surround
are registered trademarks and the DTS logos and
Symbol are trademarks of DTS, Inc. © 1996-2008
DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
For HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent
#’s: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762;
6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents
issued & pending. DTS and DTS 2.0 + Digital
Out are registered trademarks and the DTS logos
and Symbol are trademarks of DTS, Inc. © 1996-
2008 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
Published by Pioneer Corporation.
Copyright © 2009 Pioneer Corporation.
All rights reserved.
Note
1 Max. height by adjusting the speaker stand 567 mm
2 The maximum input power of this model is 100 W.
This product includes FontAvenue® fonts
licenced by NEC corporation.
FontAvenue is a registered trademark of
NEC Corporation.
DRM (digital rights management) copy
protection is a technology designed to prevent
unauthorized copying by restricting playback,
etc. of compressed audio files on devices other
than the PC (or other recording equipment)
used to record it. For detailed information,
please see the instruction manuals or help
files that came with your PC and/or software.
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 63 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
๊ᜟήِםϲޠᡚოဵȂԠӶණᒻٻң޲ݨ
ཏҐᐡܛߤழϟᐈձІᆱៗ๊ࣻᜱ२्ᇴ
݃Ȅ
๊ᜟήِםϲழԥ጑ᓟޠ଱ႬಓဵȂڐҭޠ
࣐ឍ֚ٻң޲ȂݨཏҐ౱ࠣᐡ෧ϲґ๙ጣޠ
ȶӡᓏႬᔇȷȂᗘռആԚដႬޠӡᓏȄ
ݨཏ
࣐ᗘռដႬӡᓏȂ፝ϽܷڤαίᇑȞܗन८
ݗȟȂпᗘռដႬܗڨ།ȂᐡϲณӉեѠٽ
ᆱঔٻңޠႮӈȂसሰᆱঔ݉ଡ଼፝ᖓ๝஠ཿ
ᆱঔ΢সȄ
२्
ϊȁЗ
ԥដႬޠӡᓏ
፝Ͻ҉໡
D3-4-2-1-1_A1_Zhtw
ᐈձᕘძ
ᐈձᕘძྤ࡚ᇅྡྷ࡚Ȉ
ĬĶġʨġՎġĬĴĶġʨȞĬĵIJġʩġՎġĬĺĶġʩȟȇϊܼĹĶġĦœʼn
ȞϽஈ༭տࠔЍȟ
፝ϽӶ೾ॴϛً೏ȃኹ៪ܼାྡྷ࡚ܗ໩ӏޣৣȞܗ஽੩
ޠ΢ആӏྜȟޠൠܛԋ၇ҐᐡȄ
D3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_Zhtw
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 2 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 3 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
4
Zhtw
感謝您購買本台先鋒產品。
請徹底閱讀本操作手冊,以便正確地操作您的產品。在您閱讀完手冊後,請妥為保管以便將來參
考之用。
目錄
01 揚聲器安裝指南
家庭劇院音效設置 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
5 /4 點揚聲器擺設 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
3 /2 點揚聲器擺設 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
準備揚聲器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
所有機型的相同準備工 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
僅適用於
HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP
機型的準備工作 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機型的準備工作 . . . . . . . 7
僅適用於
HTZ585DVD-AP 機型
準備工作 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
將揚聲器安裝在牆上. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
安裝前 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
僅安裝
HTZ585DVD-AP 的托架 . . . . . . . . 10
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機型的安裝工作 . . . . . . 10
揚聲器擺設之其他注意事項 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
02 接線
基本接線方式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
03 控制與顯示
前面板 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
顯示幕 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
遙控器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
安裝遙控器電池 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
運用遙控器. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
04 開始操作
設定揚聲器擺設 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
使用自動
MCACC 設定功能,以產生
最佳的環繞聲效果 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
使用在屏顯示畫面
OSD . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
碟片播放. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
基本播放控制 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
恢復播放及最終記憶播 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
DVD-Video 碟片選單. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
VCD/ 超級 VCD PBC 選單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
聆聽收音機 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
改善
FM 接收不良 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
抑制
AM 接收雜訊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
記憶電台 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
收聽預設電台 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
來自電視機的音頻輸入設定
(電視機輸入) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
聆聽其他來源 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
05 聆聽您的系統
選取聆聽模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
自動聆聽模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
以環繞聲聆聽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Dolby Pro Logic II Music 設定 . . . . . . . . 23
使用前場前環繞功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
以立體聲聆聽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
以耳機聆聽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
使用 音場補正等化」功能聆聽 . . . . . . . . . 24
使用 聲音修正器」功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
強化對白 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
使用 音調控制」功能. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
調整低音及高音 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
「靜聲」及 「午夜」模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
加重低音音量 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
06 碟片播放功能
碟片掃描 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
慢動作播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
格進/格退播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
播放
JPEG 幻燈片秀 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
使用 碟片導向」瀏覽
DVD
VCD/ 超級 VCD 碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
可利用 「碟片導向」功能瀏覽
Windows
Media
TM
Audio (WMA)MP3MPEG-4
AAC
DivX 視頻 /WMV JPEG 檔案 . . . . . 28
使用播放清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
製作播放清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
聆聽播放清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
清除播放清單上的檔案 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
循環播放碟片某個片段 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
使用重複播放功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
使用隨機播放功能 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
建立程序編輯清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
程序編輯選單中其他可用的功能. . . . . . . . . 30
搜索碟片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
切換字幕 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
切換對白語言/音頻聲 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
放大畫面 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
切換拍攝角度 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
顯示碟片資訊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 4 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
5
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
07 USB 播放與錄製
使用 USB 介面. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
USB 裝置上錄製音樂 CD 的曲目 . . . . . . . 32
錄製所有曲目 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
錄製特定曲目 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
08 卡拉 OK 伴唱
卡拉 OK 伴唱 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
變更混聲效果 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
變更背景音樂 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
09 環繞音效設定值
運用音效設定選單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
10 「視頻調整」選單
「視頻調整」選單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
11 「初始設置」選單
使用 初始設置」選單. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
數位音頻輸出設置 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
視頻輸出設定值. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
語言設定值 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
顯示幕設定值 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
選項設定值 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
成人鎖定. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
關於 DivX
®
VOD 內容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
12 其他接線
使用色差視頻輸出連接 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
關於逐行掃描視頻 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
連接數位音源 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
連接類比音頻設備 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
使用
HDMI 連接 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
切換
HDMI 音頻設置值. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
重新設定
HDMI 連接 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
關於
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
連接外部天線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
用於無線享受音樂的
Bluetooth
®
傳輸器 . . . 45
無線音樂播放 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
遙控器操作 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
連接選購的
Bluetooth 傳輸器 . . . . . . . . . . 46
配對
Bluetooth 傳輸器和
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
使用您的系統聆聽
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置的音樂內容 . . . . . 46
清除配對. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
13 KURO LINK
連接 KURO LINK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
KURO LINK 設定. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
設定
KURO LINK 模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
使用同步化之前. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
同步化擴大模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
同步化擴大模式操作 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
取消同步化擴大模式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
14 其他資訊
選項系統設定值 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
設置睡眠定時器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
碟片/內容格式播放相容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
碟片相容性參照表 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
關於
DVD+R/DVD+RW 相容性. . . . . . . . . . 52
關於
DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
關於
WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
關於
MPEG-4 AAC. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
關於
WMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
碟片的使用及維護 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
DVD Video 用地區 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
安裝及保養 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
安裝提示 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
清潔讀寫頭時 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
水氣凝結問題 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
搬動系統主機 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
畫面大小及碟片格式 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
寬螢幕電視使用者 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
標準電視使用者 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
故障排除 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
一般問題 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
DVD/CD/VCD 播放器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
調諧器. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
USB 連接. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
HDMI 連接 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Bluetooth 連線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
錯誤訊息 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
重新設置系統. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
使用語言代碼清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
語言代碼清單. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
國家/地區代碼清單 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
規格 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 5 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
揚聲器安裝指南
01
6
Zhtw
1
揚聲器安裝指南
家庭劇院音效設置
不適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD
機種
視您房間的大小及特性而定,您可以在兩種方
式中選取其一來擺設您的揚聲器以使用本系
統。關於揚聲器配置,請參閱 「設定指南」
5 /4 點揚聲器擺設
這是一種能提供最佳
5.1
聲道家庭劇院音效的
準多聲道環繞聲揚聲器設定方式。
1
3 /2 點揚聲器擺設
在無法進行後環繞揚聲器的擺設或您希望能避
免在聆聽區內佈設過長的揚聲器線時此種設定
方式相當的實用。
2
準備揚聲器
所有機型的相同準備工
安裝防滑墊
將小片防滑墊貼到每個揚聲器的底座上
塊大片的防滑墊則請貼到重低音上。
使用
用隨附的膠水將 3 4 片防滑墊貼到每個揚
聲器的底座 (平坦表面)上。
僅適用於 HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-
AP 機型的準備工作
5/4
點揚聲器和
3/2
點揚聲器的擺設相同:
組裝揚聲器腳架
利用所附贈的螺絲將揚聲器底座安裝到支
柱上。
對正支柱及底座後,請參閱 「設定指南」將小
螺絲鎖入各個螺絲孔內。請注意,揚聲器應朝
向等腰三角形的底座的方向
注意
請小心不要將螺絲鎖太緊。
如果太用力鎖緊螺絲螺絲和/或螺帽的螺
紋可能會損壞使用中等尺寸的手動螺絲起
子組裝。
請勿使用可能會對螺絲和螺帽施加過大力
量的電動螺絲起子或尺寸太大的螺絲起子
組裝時確認沒有異物黏在腳架底座或高的
揚聲器上。
如果組裝本機時腳架底座與高揚聲器之間
卡住異物則可能無法安全地組裝本
致本機翻覆或摔落。
請勿站在高揚聲器的揚聲器腳架底座上推
動或搖晃揚聲器揚聲器可能摔落和破裂
或導致人員受傷。請注意小孩。
附註
1 前置和右前置揚聲器應該相距約 1.8 m 2.7 m
2 環繞和右環繞揚聲器應該相距約 1.5 m
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 6 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
揚聲器安裝指南
01
7
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
固定您的前置與環繞聲揚聲器
使用隨附的塑膠鉤固定每個前置與環繞揚
聲器。
將兩個支撐鉤鎖入揚聲器後面的牆壁中。將一
條粗纜線穿過鉤子和塑膠鉤來固定揚聲器 (確
定先測試它是否能支撐揚聲器的重量)安裝
後,確定已牢牢固定揚聲器
注意
塑膠鉤不是固定配件而且也不應使用此鉤
子直接將揚聲器掛在牆壁上一律使用纜線
保持揚聲器的穩定。
對於因不當組裝安裝、安裝材料強度不
、誤用或天然災害造成的任何損失或損
壞,先鋒概不擔負任何責任。
放置本機時請確定已牢牢固定本機並避
免放置在可能因天然災害 (例如地震)而
掉落並造成人員受傷的區域。
僅適用於 HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP 機型的準備工作
組裝揚聲器腳架與固定您的前置揚聲器
1 使用隨附的六角螺帽和墊片,將有圓螺帽
的桿子安裝在揚聲器腳架底座中。
使用隨附的活動扳手安裝
注意
安裝桿子時請小心腳架不要讓腳架傾倒
༮ጳႚ
஋ಘޠጤ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 7 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
揚聲器安裝指南
01
8
Zhtw
2 將揚聲器腳架放在它的側然後將揚聲
連接線穿入揚聲器腳架底座的孔中,然後穿越
桿子。
3 請將隨附的蓋子裝在桿子的頂端。
請將揚聲器連接線穿入如圖所示的蓋子中間,
然後裝上蓋子。
4 將隨附的金屬扣裝在桿子上。
裝上金屬扣夾住桿子並將螺絲插入螺絲
中。
小心不要使金屬扣滑出或鬆開直到安裝好
揚聲器為止。
5 安裝揚聲器。
將揚聲器連接線連接至揚聲器的接頭。
將螺絲
M5 x 12 mm裝入在步驟 4 中安
裝的金屬扣中再裝入揚聲器的螺絲孔中
然後暫時鎖緊螺絲。
請參閱揚聲器背面的刻根據您的喜好將
左右揚聲器腳架的位置調整到相同高度
後鎖緊螺絲。
6 微調兩支桿子的位置。
調整桿子,使從側面或上方直接看到桿子時
保持豎直且水平。
ݨཏ
ࠊഌߝ឵ԛᚈޠѵםᇅࡤഌޠϛӤȄ፝
ݨཏߝ឵ԛᚈޠԋ၇РӪȄ
ࠊഌ
ࡤഌ
ᖴ๜
OK NG
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 8 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
揚聲器安裝指南
01
9
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
僅適用於 HTZ585DVD-AP 機型的準備
工作
堆疊揚聲器並使用托架固定
每個揚聲器背面的機型標籤上都有協助識別的
顏色標示指示。請參照顏色指示並正確安裝揚
聲器。
如圖所示堆疊揚聲。如以下每張圖片所示,
將托架對齊各自的上側與下側螺絲孔,然後安
全地固定螺絲。
4
/3
點揚聲器配置:
2
點揚聲器配置:
注意
連接托架時不可嘗試拿著揚聲器這樣做
會造成托架損壞或如果托架和揚聲器掉落
時導致它們的損壞更加嚴重。
將揚聲器安裝在牆上
關於 HTZ585DVD-AP,請安裝前置、中央和
環繞聲揚聲器的固定托架
HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
機型只有中置揚聲器有固定
孔。
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP 的前
置揚聲器有固定孔。
安裝前
請記得揚聲器很重同時其重量可導致螺
絲鬆脫或牆壁用材損壞難以支撐而造成
揚聲器掉落請確定您要安裝的那面牆的強
度足以支援這些揚聲器請勿安裝在膠合板
或軟質的牆壁上。
未附安裝螺絲請使用適合牆壁的材料及
可以支撐揚聲器的螺絲。
注意
如果您不確定牆壁的材質及強度,請洽詢
專業人員的意見。
先鋒對於因不正確安裝所造成的意外或損
壞,一概不負任何責任。
ࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ϜဋඵᖑᏣ
ѿဋ
ᆧՔ
कՔ
Ѣဋ
4 ᘉġĻ
ࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ᕘᙔඵᖑᏣ
ѿဋ
ᙣՔ
ҪՔ
ԹՔ
कՔ
Ѣဋ
3 ᘉġĻ
ᚠՔࡿұᐸ
ᐡᆎዀᡇ
ᆧՔ
ҪՔ
ᖴ๜
ԝ࢝
ᚠՔࡿұᐸ
ᐡᆎዀᡇ
ࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ϜဋඵᖑᏣ
ᕘᙔඵᖑᏣ
ѿဋ
ᙣՔ
ҪՔ
ᆧՔ
ԹՔ
कՔ
ᆧՔ
Ѣဋ
ᖴ๜
ϜဋඵᖑᏣ
ࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ᕘᙔඵᖑᏣ
ԝ࢝
5 mm
10 mm
5
mm
Վ 7
mm
ڿۢᖴ๜
Ȟґߤȟ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 9 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
揚聲器安裝指南
01
10
Zhtw
僅安裝 HTZ585DVD-AP 的托架
在將托架安裝到揚聲器背面時請確實儘量
將隨機附贈的螺絲上緊固定。
請勿將托架安裝到中置揚聲器。
僅適用於 HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP 機型的安裝工作
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP的前置揚聲
器可以垂直或水平地掛在牆上。使用一個孔可
以將它垂直懸掛,兩個孔則可將它水平懸掛。
水平安裝揚聲器時,請轉開前柵板的標誌。
下圖顯示右前置揚聲器
揚聲器擺設之其他注意事項
將主要的左前置及右前置揚聲器安裝在電
視機兩側同等的距離上
使用
5 點揚聲器擺設時將環繞揚聲器安裝
在稍高於耳朵高度的位置以得到最佳效果
預防事項:
將中置揚聲器安裝在電視機上方時請確實
用膠帶或其他適當的方法將其固定否則
揚聲器可能會因地震等外力震動而從電視
機上掉落危及鄰近的人員或造成揚聲器損
壞。
請確定所有裸露的揚聲器線已捲繞在一起
並完全插入揚聲器端子若有任何裸露的導
線碰觸到背面板則電源可能會因此切斷以
策安全。
本前置、中置環繞揚聲器均經過防磁處
然而需視安裝位置而定如果揚聲器
安裝太過靠近電視機畫面時仍有可能發生
色彩失真的現象。
如有發生此種情形,請
將電視機的電源關閉,
15 分鐘至 30 分鐘
後再打開。
如果問題仍然存在,請將揚聲
器安裝在遠離電視機的地方。
重低音未經防磁處理因此不可擺得太過靠
近電視機或顯示器。磁性儲存媒體 (如磁
碟片及錄音帶或錄影帶等所擺放的位置
亦不應太過接近重低音
請勿將中置揚聲器(僅
HTZ585DVD-AP
和重低音揚聲器安裝在牆上或天花板上
們可能會掉落而使人受傷。
ᖴ๜
Ȟᓎߤȟ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 10 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
接線
02
11
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
2
接線
基本接線方式
為了得到最好的環繞音效請如下所示設定您的揚聲器 下圖中的揚聲器型號 HTZ585DVD-AP
重要提示
在連接本系統或變更接線方式請確實將
電源關閉並從牆壁插座拔下電源線完成所
有接線後請將電源線連接至牆壁插座上
警告
對於錯誤組裝或安裝牆壁安裝強度不足
安裝固定配件(或其他房屋固定配件)、使
用錯誤或天然災害造成的意外事件先鋒概
不擔負任何責任。
1 組裝 AM 環型天線。
a.
將腳架折向箭頭所指方向。
b. 把環圈夾到腳架上
c. 如果您想固定到牆上或其他表面上請在利
用螺絲先固定腳架之後接著執行步驟
b
建議您先利用螺絲固定腳架後再來決定接
收強度。
AC IN
HDMI OUT
ANALOG AUDIO IN
SPEAKERS (4 )
LINE 2
L
R
Y
P
B
P
R
LR
FRONT
CENTER
LR
SURROUND
SUB
WOOFER
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO(TV)
COMPONENT
VIDEO
A
N
T
E
N
N
A
FM
UNBAL 75 AM LOOP
ADAPTER PORT
OPTICAL
LINE 1
DIGITAL AUDIO IN
ѢᕘᙔඵᖑᏣ
ȞԹՔȟ
ѢࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ȞकՔȟ
ѿࠊဋඵᖑᏣ
ȞҪՔȟ
२մॲඵᖑᏣ
Ȟ๚Քȟ
ϜဋඵᖑᏣ
ȞᆧՔȟ
ѿᕘᙔඵᖑᏣ
ȞᙣՔȟ
ರ᠚՞ဋ
Ⴌຝᐡ
ՎຝᓝᒰΤ
FM Љጤ
AM ᕘ࠯Љጤ
a b
c
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 11 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
接線
02
12
Zhtw
2 連接 AM FM 天線。
1
a. 請拉除AM天線金屬線上的保護外皮 連接
AM 環型天線的每股金屬線至各個 AM
線端子上。
2
在各個端子上,將固定片往下壓打開;然後
插入金屬線,再放開、關上固定。
b. FM天線
3
插頭壓入FM天線插座的中間接
腳內。
3-1 連接每只揚聲器。
連接金屬線至揚聲器上。
扭轉並扯下每條金屬線上的保護外皮。
將顏色標示線配好標籤上的顏色指示然後
將顏色標示線插入紅色 +)端,而
條線插入黑色 )端。
僅適用於
HTZ585DVD-AP
a. 連接中置揚聲器時以相同方法將 Y 接線兩
端連接至兩個中置揚聲器。
選擇運用托架組裝的
4 點、3 點或 2 擺設時
另請依照以下的步驟
b
b. 完成接線時請固定揚聲器連接線將連接
線固定在托架的溝槽中
附註
1 將天線放置在遠離接收器或其他連接線的位置。
如果使用所附天線的接收不良,則請參閱第 20
改善
FM
接收不良
來改善。
請勿將安裝隨附的環形天線以外的任何天線,或如 45 頁所述的外部天線。
2 請勿讓其接觸到金屬物體並避免擺在電腦、電視機或其他電氣設備的附近。
如果收音機接收不良,您可以將每條天線金屬線重新插入相對的端子內或可有所改善。
為了能有最佳的接收條件,請勿將 AM 環型天線金屬線解開或將它們環繞整個環型天線。
3 欲確保最佳的接收條件,請確實將 FM 天線完全伸展開來,不可捲曲或懸掛於本機的後方。
1
2
3
ᚠՔዀұጤ
Ȟഀ௦ՎඵᖑᏣȟ
ᚠՔዀұ௦ᓟ
Ȟഀ௦Վࡤ८ݗȟġ
༄Ք
(–)
ᚠՔዀұጤ
कՔ
(+)
Y ഀ௦ጤ
Վлᐡ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 12 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
接線
02
13
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
3-2 連接接收器上的每一個揚聲器端子。
連接另一端至接收器背面上有標示顏色的
揚聲器端子上。
確定已完全插入。
揚聲器插頭在金屬線端處的小型端子應視
連接的是上或下揚聲器端子來面朝上或朝
下。
請確實正確地連接。
注意
這些揚聲器端子均帶有危險電
為避免
在連接或脫離揚聲器線時發生電擊危險,
在觸摸任何未絕緣部分之前,請先將電源
線插頭拔離。
請勿將隨機附贈以外的揚聲器連接至本系
統上。
請勿將隨附的揚聲器連接至不是隨本系統
一起附上的擴大器。
連接至其他的擴大器
上可能會導致故障或起火。
連接插頭後輕拉連接線以確定連接線端牢
牢連接至端子。
連接不良可能造成雜訊和
聲音中斷。
如果連接線的線路正好退出端子外讓線路
互相接觸造成擴大器過大的額外負載
樣可能導致擴大器停止作用甚至可能損壞
擴大器。
4 將其中一端連接至您的電視機的視頻輸入
插孔。
請使用附贈的視頻連接線
5 將另一端連接至接收器的視頻輸出插
孔。
本機配備防拷技術請勿使用影音連接線
透過錄放影機將本機連接至您的電視機
否則本機的影像無法在您的電視機上正常
顯示。
6 連接電源線。
1
連接電源線至接收器上的AC插座 連接電
源線至牆壁插座。
αРᆓφ ίРᆓφ
附註
1 請勿使用非隨本系統所附贈的其他電源線。
隨機附贈的電源線除了連接本系統外,請勿做其他用途
AC IN
Վ AC ඩ৵
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 13 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
控制與顯示
03
14
Zhtw
3
控制與顯示
前面板
下圖顯示 HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
1 STANDBY/ON (第 17183346
55 以及 57 頁)
可將系統開機或切換成待機狀態。
2 OPEN/CLOSE (第 1933 以及 56 頁)
開啟/關閉碟盤。
3 功能
4
5
6VOLUME +/(第 19 頁)
7 碟盤 19 頁)
8 電源指示燈會 (藍色)
9 遙控感應器 (第 16 頁)
10 顯示
11 USB 介面 (第 32 頁)
12 MIC 輸入插孔 (第 34 頁)
MCACC 插孔 HTZ585DVD-AP/
HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP
(第 18 頁)
13 PHONES 插孔 (第 24 頁)
顯示幕
1 解碼指示燈 (第 22 頁)
DTS 來源播放期間 DTS 亮起。2PL II
2
Dolby Pro Logic II 解碼時亮起2D 在播放
杜比數位音源時亮起。
2PRGSVE(第 43 頁)
色差影像輸出端子輸出逐行掃描訊號時,便會
亮起。
3 SOUND (第 24 頁)
在聲音修正器啟動時會亮起
4SURR.(第 22 以及 24 頁)
在選取其中一種先進環繞聲模式或
PHONESUR (耳機專用虛擬環繞聲)時會
亮起。
F.SURR.
23
其中一個前場前環繞模式選取時會亮起。
5RPT RPT-1 (第 29 頁)
RPT 在重複播放期間會亮起RPT-1 在重複播放
單曲期間會亮起。
6PGM(第 28 以及 30 頁)
此燈在程序播放期間會亮起
7 調諧器指示燈 (第 20 頁)
收聽到廣播節目時會亮起 收聽到立
體聲
FM 廣播節目時會亮起, 在選取 FM
單聲道接收時會亮起。
8RDM(第 29 頁)
此燈在隨機播放期間會亮起
USB
PHONES
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
USB
OPEN/CLOSE
STANDBY/ON
FUNCTION
VOLUME

MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
PHONES
11 13
521
7 8
9
10
3 4
6
12
PRGSVE SOUND
DTS F.SURR.
2PL
2D
RPT -1
kHz
PGM
MHz RDM
6
12 89 7
5
11
3
10
21 4
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 14 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
控制與顯示
03
15
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
9 kHz/MHz
為指示字元顯示幕中所顯示的頻率單位 kHz
適用於
AMMHz 適用於 FM)。
10 字元顯示幕
11 (第 51 頁)
此燈在睡眠定時啟動時會亮起。
12
此燈在播放期間會亮起。
遙控器
下圖顯示 HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD-AP
1 STANDBY/ON (第 17183346
55 以及 57 頁)
2 功能選取按鍵
3 數字鍵
CLEAR
DISPLAY
(第 31 頁)
SHIFT+SLEEP
51
SHIFT+USB REC
(第 33 頁)
SHIFT+AUDIO
(第 31 頁)
SHIFT+SUBTITLE
(第 31 頁)
SHIFT+ANGLE
(第 31 頁)
SHIFT+ZOOM
(第 31 頁)
4TOP MENU(第 20 以及 31 頁)
SHIFT+SETUP (第
17
20
21
44
46
47
49
50
以及
60
頁)
5 游標按鍵
ENTER
TUNE (第 20 頁)
PRESET
(第 21 頁)
6HOME MENU
SHIFT+MCACC (僅適用於 HTZ585DVD
-AP/HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP
(第 18 頁)
7 音效控制
AUTO
/
STEREO (第 22 以及 24 頁)
SURROUND (第 2223 以及 24 頁)
SOUND (第 24 以及 25 頁)
SOUND RETRIEVER (第 24 頁)
8 播放控制 (第 19 以及 26 頁)
9TV CONTROL按鍵
可用於控制先鋒平面電視
1
10 SHIFT
1
USB REC
CLEAR
TOP MENU
TUNE
ECHO
TUNE
MCACC
KARAOKE
MENU
MIC VOL
PLAYLIST
OPEN/CLOSE
RETURN
SETUP
AUTO/
STEREO
SOUND
RETRIEVERSURROUND
SOUND
CLASS
VOLUMECHANNEL
T V CONTROL
INPUT
SHIFT VOLUME
MUTE
T.EDIT
PRESET PRESET
AUDIO
ANGLE
SLEEP
SUBTITLE
ADAPTER PORT
USB LINE
TUNER
(
FM/AM
)
DVD/CD
STANDBY
/ON
ZOOM
DISPLAY
23
456
789
0
HOME
MENU
1
2
3
ENTER
1
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2
11
12
13
15
16
17
18
14
附註
1 按住數字鍵 1 超過三秒,同時按下 CLEAR。如果電視拒絕回應,請按住數字鍵 2。正確切換控制後,將 TV CONTROL
向電視並按下它可操作到電視機的功率。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 15 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
控制與顯示
03
16
Zhtw
11 OPEN/CLOSE (第 1933 以及 56 頁)
12 PLAYLIST 按鍵 (第 28 頁)
13 MIC VOL +/(第 34 頁)
14 MENU (第 2027 以及 31 頁)
15 RETURN
16 調諧器控制鍵
CLASS (第 21 頁)
SHIFT+T.EDIT
(第 21 頁)
17 MUTE
18 VOLUME +/– (第 19 頁)
安裝遙控器電池
1 打開遙控器背面上的電池室蓋。
2 對照電池室內的標示)將 AA/
R6 電池插入電池室內。
3 關上電池室蓋。
注意
電池使用不當會導致如電池液外漏及爆裂等危
險發生。請遵守下列事項:
將電池插入電池槽請務必依電池槽內的
指示將電池的極性對準正極 與負極
極性。
切勿將新舊電池混用。
相同類型的電池可能有不同的電壓視品牌
而定。請勿混用不同品牌的電池。
處理廢舊電池時請遵守政府條例或適用
貴國或地區的環境公共指令規則。
為了避免電池漏液,長時間 (一個月或更
)不使用遙控器時請取出遙控器的電
如果漏液請小心擦掉電池槽內的任何
電池液,然後換用新電池。
請勿讓書本或其他物體壓在遙控器上因為
這樣可能壓住按鍵造成電池的電量更快耗
盡。
切勿在車內或加熱器附近等會受到陽光直
射或過熱的環境中使用或存放電池過熱的
環境可能導致電池破漏過熱爆炸或起
火。還會減少電池的使用壽命或效能。
運用遙控器
遙控器的使用範圍為距離前面板感應器的 7 m
內,而且在 30° 內。
如果遙控器和顯示裝置之間有障礙物或如
果遙控器未以正確角度指向顯示裝置的遙
控感應器,則遙控器可能無法作用。
如果陽光直射或螢光燈等強制照到本機的
遙控感應器上則遙控器可能無法正常作
用。
如果在靠近會發射紅外線的裝置或其他裝
置的紅外線遙控器的位置使用本機則遙控
器可能無法正常作用此外使用此遙控器
可能造成其他裝置的運作異常。
遙控器的操作範圍變得太短時,請更換電
池。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 16 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
開始操作
04
17
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
4
開始操作
設定揚聲器擺設
不適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機種
選擇您為您的聆聽區環境安排的揚聲器設定的
揚聲器擺設。
第一次開啟系統電源時,顯示下列的揚聲器擺
設設定
如果您未完成此設定即關閉系統電
下次開啟系統電源時會再次顯示相同內容
1 STANDBY/ON然後確認顯示幕顯示
WELCOME (歡迎使用)
2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT (選擇揚聲器
擺設)將在顯示幕上執行約 10 秒鐘。
3 使用 / 選取適當的揚聲器擺設。
您可以選擇的揚聲器擺設隨使用的機型而異。
如需有關揚聲器擺設與模式說明的詳細資料,
請參閱 設定指南」
5 SPOT -將兩個環繞揚聲器放置在聆聽位
置後面,最適用於
5.1 道家庭電影院的
聲音。
4 SPOT(僅適用於 HTZ585DVD-AP-這
是用於聆聽環繞聲的標準擺設,類似
5
揚聲器擺設。
兩個中置揚聲器分別放在右
側和左則,並整齊地擺放在電視旁邊。
3 SPOT -這是用「前置環繞聲」模式的
典型擺設。
兩個環繞揚聲器放在聆聽位置
前面。
2 SPOT(僅適用於 HTZ585DVD-AP-此
配置適用於 「前置環繞聲」模式,和
3
揚聲器擺設相同
兩個中置揚聲器分別放
在右側和左則並整齊地擺放在電視旁邊
4 按下 ENTER 確認調整。
1
使用自動 MCACC 設定功能,以
產生最佳的環繞聲效果
不適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機種
多聲道音場自動補正 MCACC)系統可測量
您聆聽區域內的音場特性,將周遭雜訊納入考
量,並測試聲道延遲及聲道音量。
在您完成系
統附贈的麥克風設置後,接收器便可使用來自
一連串測試音調的資訊來測量迴響,將揚聲器
設定值及等化效果 (音場補正等化功能)調整
至最符合個人特別房間條件的狀態。
2
重要提示
測試音量很大但在設定期間請勿調低音
量,以免降低最佳補正品質。
MCACC設置期間請確定不要移動麥克風
及揚聲器。
附註
1 若要變更設定,請按 SHIFT+SETUP,使用 / 選取 SYS SET,然後使用 / 選取 LAYOUT 以開始設定程序。
2 您只需要使用自動 MCACC 設定一次 (除非您的揚聲器擺置或室內陳設有所變動)
1
USB REC
PLAYLIST
OPEN /CLOSE
AUDIO SUBTITLE
ADAPTER PORT
USB
LINE
TUNER
(
FM/AM
)
DVD/CD
STANDBY
/ON
23
456
1
2
3
TOP MENU
TUNE
TUNE
MCACC
MENU
RETURN
SETUP
AUTO/
STEREO
SOUND
RETRIEVERSURROUND
SOUND
PRESET PRESET
HOME
MENU
ENTER
ECHO
KARAOKE
VOLUMECHANNEL
INPUT
SHIFT VOLUME
MUTE
T.EDIT
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 17 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
開始操作
04
18
Zhtw
1 連接麥克風至前面板上的 MCACC MIC
孔。
2 請將麥克風放在您一般聆聽的位置上。
請將其置於大約耳朵的高度,並最好利用桌子
或椅子以確保水平。
確定揚聲器與麥克風之間沒有任何障礙物。
3 若系統關閉,請按 STANDBY/ON 開啟
電源。
揚聲器擺設選單出現時,請參閱第
17 頁的
定揚聲器擺設
並選取合適的設定。
4 按下 SHIFT+MCACC
在按下 SHIFT+MCACC ,請儘量保持安靜。
音量會自動提高,同時系統會輸出一連串測試
音調。
按下 SHIFT+MCACC 取消並回復先前的
MCACC 設定值。
如果雜音音量太高,NOISY 字樣便會在螢
幕中顯示約五秒鐘時間
退出並檢查雜
音音量
1
,請 SHIFT+MCACC,或 RETRY
字樣出現於螢幕上時再試一次按下
ENTER
如果您在螢幕上見到 ERR MICERR SP
訊息字樣,則表示您的麥克風或揚聲器在
連接上有問題。
要再試一次時,請您在見
RETRY 字樣時,按下 ENTER
2
MCACC 設定完成時,音量會恢復正常且顯示
幕會顯示 COMPLETE
3
,表示 MCACC 設定完
成且音場補正等化功能已啟動。
4
完成 「自動 MCACC 設定」時,確定斷開
麥克風與本機的連接。
使用在屏顯示畫面 OSD
為了使用方便,本系統採用了大量圖形化的在
屏顯示畫面
OSD)。
所有畫面的導覽方式基本上並無不同,請使用
變更反白項目並按下 ENTER
完成選取。
5
重要提示
整本手冊「選取」是指使用游標按鍵反白
在屏畫面中的項目,再按下 ENTER 之意。
附註
1 若室內環境並非完全適合自動 MCACC 設定 (雜音、牆壁迴音太多,有障礙物擋在揚聲器與麥克風之間),最終設定值
可能會不正確。
請確認家電用品 (空調、冰箱、電風扇等)是否會影響環境,並視需要將它們關閉。
某些舊式的電視機可能會干擾到麥克風的操作。 若發生此種情形,進行自動 MCACC 設定時,請將電視機關閉。
USB
PHONES
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
2 若仍未能有所改善,請按下 SHIFT+MCACC 將電源關閉,並確認錯誤訊息所代表的問題,然後再嘗試一次自動 MCACC
定。
3 如果螢幕上並未顯示 COMPLETE 字樣,則表示可能在設置期間有錯誤發生。 請檢查所有接線並再試一次。
4 請參閱第 24 頁的
使用 「音場補正等化」功能聆聽
開啟/關閉音場補正等化功能。
5 螢幕保護程序會在系統閒置五分鐘後出現。
按鍵 按鍵功能
HOME
MENU
顯示/退出在屏顯示畫面 OSD

變更反白的選單項目
ENTER
選取反白的選單項目
RETURN
返回主選單不做任何變更
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 18 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
開始操作
04
19
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
提示
OSD 畫面下方的按鍵指南可告訴您操作
畫面所需使用的按鍵。
碟片播放
播放 DVDCDVCD/ 超級 VCDDivX 視頻 /
WMV
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 等碟片的
基本播放控制在此均適用
更多的功能會在第
6
章中詳細說明。
1 如果播放器尚未開機,請將它開機。
如果您正在播放含有影像的碟片,請同時將電
視機打開並確定設置的是正確的視頻輸入。
2 按下 OPEN/CLOSE 以置入碟片。
標籤面朝上置入碟片,利用碟片導槽對準碟片
(如果您置入的是雙面
DVD 碟片置入時請將
想要播放的一面朝下)
3 按下 (播放)以開始播放。
如果您播放的是
DVD VCD/ 超級 VCD,便
會出現一選單。
請參閱 DVD-Video
碟片選單
及第 20 頁的 VCD/
超級
VCD PBC
選單
內容
以熟知導覽的方法。
若是您置入的碟片當中含有
JPEG則會開始幻
燈片秀
與其相關的更多資訊請參閱第 26
播放
JPEG
幻燈片秀
若碟片內含
DivX視頻/WMV其他媒體檔
案類型 (例
MP3,首先請從螢幕操作
畫面
OSD)中選取要播放 DivX 視頻 /
WMV
檔案 DivX/WMV)或其他媒體檔
案類型 MP3
/WMA/JPEG/MPEG-4
AAC)。
4 音量調整。
請使用 VOLUME +/– 來控制音量。
基本播放控制
以下表格所示為遙控器上用以播放碟片的基
本控制。
1
您在第 6 章中可以找到其他的播放
功能。
恢復播放及最終記憶播放
您停止播放碟片時,RESUME (恢復)字樣會
出現在螢幕中,表示您可以從該點位置來恢復
播放。
對於
DVD VCD/ 超級 VCD 而言即使退出
播放位置亦會儲存在記憶體裏。
2
次您置入
碟片時螢幕上即會顯示 LAST MEM(最終記
憶)的字樣,同時讓您從此恢復播放。
附註
1 在您播放某些 DVD 碟片時,您會發現有些播放控制可能無法用來播放碟片中的某些部分
按鍵 按鍵功能
開始/恢復正常播放。
如果螢幕上顯示 RESUME (恢復)
LAST MEM (最終記憶)的字樣,
則播放作業便會從恢復播放或最後記憶
的位置開始 (請參閱下列
恢復播放及
最終記憶播放
)。
暫停/繼續播放碟片。
可停止播放或取消恢復播放功能 (如
果螢幕上顯示
RESUME
(恢復)
樣)
按下可開始向後快轉。
按下可開始向前快轉。
可跳至目前曲目或章節的開頭,以及前
一個曲目/章節。
可跳至下一個曲目或章節
數字鍵 可用以輸入標題/章節/曲目的編號。
按下 ENTER 按鍵以作出選取。
如果碟片停止,則會從所選標題
DVD)或曲目 CD/VCD/ 超級
VCD)的開頭處開始播放。
如果碟片正在播放,則會從所選標
VR 模式 DVD-R/-RW、章節 DVD-
Video
)或曲目 CD/VCD/ 超級
VCD)的開頭處開始播放。
2 「恢復播放」及 「最終記憶播放」功能可能不適用某些碟片。
對於 DVD-Video 碟片 (除 VR 模式 DVD-R/-RW 外),本機可儲存最後五片的播放位置。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 19 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
開始操作
04
20
Zhtw
如果您想要清除恢復播放的位置,請在螢幕上
顯示 RESUME(恢復)的字樣時按下 (停
止)
DVD-Video 碟片選單
許多 DVD-Video 碟片內含您可以選取想要觀
賞內容的選單。
有時,
DVD-Video 選單會自動在您開始播放時
顯示在螢幕上;其他碟片只會在您按下 MENU
TOP MENU 時才會顯示。
VCD/ 超級 VCD PBC 選單
某些 VCD/ 超級 VCD 具有您可從中選取想要觀
賞內容的選單
這些便是 PBC (播放控制)
單。
您可以直接利用數字鍵選取曲目,不用按下
(播放)按鍵來開始播放,而無須導覽
PBC
選單,便可播放整張 PBC VCD/ 超級 VCD
聆聽收音機
調諧器可以接收 FM AM 兩種廣播,並讓您
記憶喜愛收聽的電台,使您無須每次要收聽時
還要手動調諧。
1 按下 TUNER 以切換調諧器然後連續按以
選取 AM FM 波段。
螢幕此時會顯示波段及頻率
2 調選需要的頻率。
這裡有三種調諧模式-手動、自動及高速:
手動調諧
連續按 TUNE以改變所顯示的頻
率。
自動調諧
按住 TUNE直到所顯示的頻率
開始變動為止然後將按鍵放開
一旦
到下一個電台調諧器即會停止動
複步驟以繼續搜索。
高速調諧
按住 TUNE直到顯示的頻率開
始快速變動為止。
繼續按住按鍵直到您
找到所需要的頻率。
如有必要,可使用手
動調諧功能來微調頻率
改善 FM 接收不良
如果您正在以立體聲收聽 FM 電台,但接收卻
很微弱,那麼您可以將它切換成單聲道來改善
聲音的品質。
1 調選至一 FM 廣播電台,然後按下
SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 以選 TUNERSET,然後按下
ENTER
3 使用 / 以選取 FM MODE,然後按下
ENTER
4 使用 / 以選取 FM MONO,然後按下
ENTER
調諧器在單聲道接收模式下單聲道指示燈
)會亮起。
按鍵 按鍵功能
TOP MENU
顯示 DVD 碟片的 「上層選單」
此項功能會視碟片而有所不
同。
MENU
可顯示 DVD 碟片選單-這會依碟
片而有所不同,同時可能 「上
層選單」功能相同。

在畫面上四面移動游標。
ENTER
選取目前選單上的選項。
RETURN
返回前一個顯示的選單畫面。
數字鍵 可選取編有號碼的選單選項
適用於某些碟片)
按下 ENTER
按鍵以作出選取。
按鍵 按鍵功能
RETURN
顯示 PBC 選單。
數字鍵 選取編有號碼的選單選項。
按下
ENTER 按鍵以作出選取。
顯示前一個選單頁 (如果有的
話)
顯示下一個選單頁 (如果有的
話)
按鍵 按鍵功能
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 20 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
開始操作
04
21
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
選取上述的 FM AUTO 以切換回自動立體聲模
(收聽立體聲廣播時立體聲指示燈
會亮起)
抑制 AM 接收雜訊
AM 收情況非常不好,或正在收聽的 AM
電台太過吵雜,則請嘗試使用 「雜訊抑制」
能調整至較佳的音質。
1 調諧至 AM 廣播電台,然後按下
SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 選取 TUNERSET,然後按下
ENTER
3 使用 / 選取 NOISECUT,然後按下
ENTER
4 使用 / 選取雜訊抑制模式,然後按下
ENTER
選取
1 2 之間的效果位準。
記憶電台
此系統可以記憶最多 30 個電台,儲存在三個
類別
AB C每個類別可儲存 10
電台。
1 調諧至 AM FM 廣播電台。
可視需要來選取單聲道或自動立體聲
FM)的
接收方式。
這些設定值會與預設值一併儲存。
2 按下 SHIFT+T.EDIT
3 按下 CLASS 可選取三個類別的其中之一,
然後使用 PRESET 按鍵選取您要的預設電台。
您也可以使用數字鍵來選取預設電台。
4 按下 ENTER
ENTER 預設類別和編號停止閃爍然後
系統記憶電台。
收聽預設電台
您必須先儲存一些預設值才能執行此操作。
1 確定已選取 TUNER 功能。
2 按下 CLASS 以選取儲存頻道所在的類別。
重覆按下可切換 AB C 類別。
3 使用 PRESET 按鍵以選取一預設電台。
您也可以使用數字鍵來選取預設電台。
來自電視機的音頻輸入設定
(電視機輸入)
若要用此裝置聆聽來自平面電視的音頻,您必
須連接音頻線而不是
HDMI 連接線 從此選單
設定您要連接的音頻輸入
僅當 KURO
LINK
設定為 LINK ON 並且本機連接至
KURO LINK 相容先鋒平面電視時此設定有效
(請參閱第
48 頁的 KURO LINK
設定
)。
從輸入 DIGITAL AUDIO
(LINE1) ANALOG
AUDIO (LINE2) 中選取
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP 並使用 / 選取 SYS
SET,然後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / 以選取 TV INPUT,然後按下
ENTER
3 使用 / 以調整設定值,再按下 ENTER
確認。
聆聽其他來源
可將輔助來源 (電視機衛星接收器等)連接
至本機上,透過揚聲器系統播放。
與其相關的
更多資訊,請參閱第
43 頁的
使用色差視頻輸
出連接
要將一
USB裝置連接至USB端子上請參閱
32 頁的 USB
播放與錄製
僅適用於
HTZ585/787/FS30DVD-AP
插入和偵測到 Bluetooth 傳輸器後,即可
選擇。
與其相關的更多資訊,請參閱 45
頁的
用於無線享受音樂的
Bluetooth
®
輸器
1 確定外部來源 電視機衛星接收器等
已經開機。
2 按下 LINE 以選取來源。
每次按下即在 LINE
1
LINE
2
之間切換。
3 如有必要,可開始播放來源。
04_Getting_started.fm Page 21 Thursday, April 23, 2009 3:04 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
聆聽您的系統
05
22
Zhtw
5
聆聽您的系統
重要提示
本機的音頻功能限制視 聲音來源」設定
HDMI 音頻設定而定(第 44 頁)。此
選單可能不會顯示,或改為顯示訊息
59 頁)
選取聆聽模式
您可以使用各種聆聽模式享受不同的音效,及
根據您的喜好修正音場。您可以設定不同的聆
聽模式視您在第
6 頁的
家庭劇院音效設置
擇的揚聲器擺設而定。請閱讀以下內容並進行
每個設定。
5 /4 點揚聲器擺設
當您已選擇
5 /4 點揚聲器配置時請從環繞
聲模式中選擇一個聆聽模式。請參閱下列
以環
繞聲聆聽
3 /2 點揚聲器配置
當您已選擇
3 /2 點揚聲器配置時請從前場
前環繞聆聽模式中選擇一個聆聽模式。請參閱
23 頁的
使用前場前環繞功能
自動聆聽模式
自動聆聽模式是聆聽主要控制的各種來源最簡
單的方法:自揚聲器的輸出反映出來源題材中
的通道。
按下 AUTO/STEREO 以選取 AUTO 聆聽模
式。
1
根據揚聲器擺設設定自動選取模式。
2
以環繞聲聆聽
適用於
HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
當您將系統擺設為 5 /4 點揚聲器擺設時
使用環繞聲模式。
您可以環繞聲來聆聽立體聲或多聲道來源。環
繞聲來自於採用某種
Dolby Pro Logic 解碼模
式的立體聲來源。
連續SURROUND以選取一種聆聽模式
1
顯示幕中所出現的選取會依播放的來源類型而
有所不同。
STANDARD -標準解碼模式 只有在來
源為多聲道時,才能選擇此模式)
MOVIE
(Dolby Pro Logic II Movie Pro
Logic II 5.1
聲道環繞音效,特別適合電影
來源 (可用於任何一種雙聲道來源)
附註
1 若來源為 Dolby Digital DTS,則前面板顯示幕中的相對指示燈會亮起。
來源
5 SPOT
4 SPOT
3 SPOT
2 SPOT
雙聲道
STEREO STEREO
多聲道
STANDARD FOCUS5.1
Dolby
surround
MOVIE FOCUS5.1
2
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
雙聲道設定為 STEREO多聲道和 Dolby Surround 設定為 FOCUS
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 22 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
聆聽您的系統
05
23
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
MUSIC (Dolby Pro Logic II Music
產生
Pro Logic II 5.1 道環繞音效,特別
適合音樂來源 (適用於雙聲道來源)
DOLBY PL
(Dolby Pro Logic 可產
4.1 聲道環繞音效 (適用於雙聲道來源)
以下所示的每個模式是先鋒原有的音場模式,
被稱為先進環繞聲模式。
ACTION -針對有動態音軌的動作影片而
設計
UNPLUGED 適用於原音音樂來源
EXPANDED -可製造出特別寬廣的立體聲
音場
TV SURR -為單音和立體聲電視音源提供
環繞聲
SPORTS -適用於體育節目類型
ADV.GAME -適用於電視遊戲器
X-STEREO(擴展立體聲)-使用您所有的
揚聲器提供多聲道聲音給立體聲來源
Dolby Pro Logic II Music 設定
在以 Dolby Pro Logic II Music 模式聆聽時
可以調整三項設定值中置寬度尺寸及全景
1 Dolby Pro Logic II Music 模式啟動下,
按下 SOUND
2 使用 / 以選取 C.WIDTHDIMEN
PANORAMA,然後按下 ENTER
C.WIDTH(中置寬度)
藉由伸展右前置
與左前置揚聲器之間的中置聲提供更為
寬廣的前置揚聲器範圍,來產生更寬 (高
設定值)或更窄 (低設定值)的音效。
DIMEN(尺寸)
可調整由前到後的環繞
音效平衡令音效聽起來更遠(負設定值
或更近 (正設定值)
PANORAMA (全景
可延伸前置立體
聲映像以涵蓋環繞揚聲器,產 環抱
的效果。
3 使用 / 以調整每個設定值。
C.WIDTH 在範圍 0 7 間調整。
DIMEN 在範 3 +3 調整。
對於 PANORAMA,從 PNRM OFF PNRM
ON 間選取。
4 按下 ENTER 確認調整。
使用前場前環繞功能
當您使用第 17 頁中所述的 3 /2 點揚聲器擺
設時,前場前環繞模式將特別有用。
連續 SURROUND 以選取前場前環繞模
式。
FOCUS5.1
使用將可直接對左右揚聲器
音效投射涵蓋範圍的中置區域,提供豐富
的環繞聲效果。
WIDE5.1 使用以較 FOCUS5.1 式,對
更大的範圍區域提供環繞音效。
EXTRAPWR 環繞揚聲器輸出立體聲音
(若為多聲道來源,
向下混合的立體音
效),以獲得強大的立體聲效果。
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
FOCUS 相當於上文的 FOCUS5.1
WIDE
相當於上文的 WIDE5.1
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 23 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
聆聽您的系統
05
24
Zhtw
以立體聲聆聽
您可以在立體聲音效下聆聽任何一種來源―立
體聲或多聲道。在播放多聲道來源時,所有聲
道會經縮混後傳送至前置左/右揚聲器及重低
音之中。
在自動位準控制立體聲模式
A.L.C.)中,如
果每個聲音位準隨著可攜式音頻播放器錄製的
音樂來源改變,本機會等化播放聲音位準。
連續按 AUTO/STEREO 以選取 STEREO
A.L.C. 模式。
以耳機聆聽
耳機接上時,只有
STEREO
(預設值)
A.L.C
PHONESUR 耳機專用虛擬環繞聲)模式
可以使用。
耳機接上時,按下 AUTO/STEREO
SURROUND 以選取 STEREOA.L.C
PHONESUR
使用 「音場補正等化」功能聆聽
您可以使用第 17 頁的
使用自動
MCACC
設定
功能以產生最佳的環繞聲效果
中所設定的
「音場補正等化」功能聆聽來源。
1
1 按下 SOUND 並使用 / 選取 MCACC
EQ,然後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / 以選取 EQ ON EQ OFF,然
按下 ENTER 確認。
若選取 EQ OFF,等化功能會設定為關閉,
但揚聲器設定值 (聲道延遲及聲道位準
仍然有效。
自動
MCACC 設定完成時會自動選取
EQ
ON
使用 「聲音修正器」功能
音頻資料在 WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 壓縮過
程移除時聲音品質通常會出現不均勻的音像
「聲音修正器」功能採用最新的
DSP 技術,能
藉由恢復聲壓及修整壓縮後所留下的人工缺
陷,將
CD 品質的聲音恢復成壓縮的雙聲道音
頻。
聆聽立體聲來源時,按下 SOUND
RETRIEVER 以選 RTRV ON RTRV OFF
強化對白
「對白強化功能是設計用來突顯存在於電視
或電影音效中在其他背景聲音裡的對白。
1 按下 SOUND 並使用 / 選取
DIALOGUE,然後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / 以選取對白強化的程度然後按
ENTER 確認。
選取 OFFMIDMAX AUTO
使用 「音調控制」功能
您可利用音調控制選單變更聲音的音調平衡。
1 按下 SOUND 並使用 / 選取 TONE,然
後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / 選取想要調整的選項,然後按
ENTER
低音/高音聲及午夜等功能無法同時使用
附註
1「音場補正等化」功能在戴上耳機時不會有所作用。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 24 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
聆聽您的系統
05
25
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
調整低音及高音
使用音調控制調整低音及高音。
使用 /選取BASS TREBLE然後使用
/ 調整音調。按下 ENTER 確認調整。
低音和高音的調整範圍在
6dB
+6dB
間。
「靜聲」及 「午夜」模式
寂靜聆聽功能可降低聲音來源中過度的低音或
高音。
午夜聆聽功能可讓您以低度的音量聆聽效果強
勁的電影環繞聲。
在按下 ENTER 即可開啟/關閉設定值
要取消靜聲及午夜聆聽模式請選取 BASS/
TRE
加重低音音量
本機共有二種低音模式,您可用來增強來源中
的低音音量。
1
1 按下 SOUND 並使用 / 選取
BASSMODE,然後按下 ENTER
2 使用/調整聲音然後按下ENTER確認
選取 OFFMUSICCINEMA AUTO
附註
1 低音模式在戴上耳機時不會有所作用。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 25 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
26
Zhtw
6
碟片播放功能
重要提示
即使某些功能的實際操作會因置入的碟片
種類而有些許上的差異,本章所涵蓋的許
多功能仍可適用於
DVD 碟片VCD/ 超級
VCDCDDivX 視頻 /WMV 以及
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC/JPEG 碟片。
有些
DVD 會限制某些功能(例如隨機或
複播放)對碟片的部分或全部的使用
不是故障。
在播放
VCD/超級VCD某些功能在PBC
播放期間並不適用如果您想要使用這些功
請使用數字鍵選取曲目來開始碟片的
放。
碟片掃描
您可以各種的速度向前或向後快速掃描碟片
1
播放期間,按下 以開始掃描
連續按下以增加掃描速 如在屏顯示)
要恢復播放,按下 (播放)按鍵。
2
慢動作播放
您可以四種慢動作速度來播放 DVDVCD/
VCD DivX 視頻 /WMVDVD 碟片還可
以反向慢動作播放。
1 播放期間,按下 (暫停)按鍵。
2 按住 / / 按鍵直到開始慢動
作播放為止。
連續按以變更慢動作播放速(如在屏顯示)
要恢復播放,按下 (播放)按鍵。
2
格進/格退播放
您可以逐格向前或後退的方式播放 DVD 碟片
對於
VCD/ 超級 VCD DivX 視頻 /WMV,您
只可以使用格進播放。
1 播放期間,按下 (暫停)按鍵。
2 按下 / / 按鍵以後退或前進的
方式一次一格播放。
要恢復播放,按下 (播放)按鍵。
2
播放 JPEG 幻燈片秀
在置入內含 JPEG 圖片的碟片後,請按下
開始從碟片上的第一個資料夾/圖片開始幻燈
片秀
3
本機會按字母順序來顯示每一個資料夾
中的圖片。
若該裝置內含有 WMA/MP3/MPEG-4
AAC
檔案,則幻燈片秀及音頻檔案會不斷
重複播放。音頻播放期間,您仍然可以使
用跳過
/、掃描 /
及暫停 )等各項功能。
圖片會自動調整以盡量填滿整個螢幕畫面。
附註
1DivX視頻 /WMV 碟片僅適用一種速度。
2 視碟片而定,正常的播放會在讀取到 DVD 碟片上新的章節時,自動恢復。
對於 PBC 模式中的 VCD/ 超級 VCD 以及 WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 曲目 (限 「掃描模式」中),到達曲目的開頭或結
尾時將恢復正常播放。
3 本機將一份檔案載入的時間會隨著檔案容量愈大而增加。
一張碟片可包含多 299 個資料夾及 648 個合併的資料夾與檔案。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 26 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
27
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
幻燈片秀播放時:
使用 「碟片導向」瀏覽 DVD
VCD/ 超級 VCD 碟片
使用 「碟片導向」可瀏覽整張 DVD VCD/
超級VCD碟片的內容找到您想要播放的部分
1 播放期間按下 HOME MENU 並從在屏選
單中選取 Disc Navigator (碟片導向)
2 選取檢視選項。
可以使用的選項視置入的碟片種類及是否要播
放碟片而定,然而仍包含
Title(標題)
DVD-Video碟片中的標
題。
Chapter(章節)
DVD-Video 碟片目
前標題中的章節。
Track
(曲目) VCD/超級 VCD碟片中
的曲目。
Time(時間)
VCD/ 超級 VCD 碟片中
每十分鐘一個的縮圖。
Original: Title(標題)
VR模式DVD-
R/-RW
碟片中的原始標題。
Playlist: Title(標題)
VR 模式 DVD-
R/-RW
碟片當中的播放清單標題。
Original: Time (時間)
指原始內容中
每十分鐘一個的縮圖。
Playlist: Time(時間)
指播放清單中每
十分鐘一個的縮圖。
整個螢幕畫面前後一次最多可接連顯示六張縮
圖影像。要顯示前一組/下一組六張縮圖,按
/
3 選取您要播放的縮圖影像。
您可使用 /// ENTER 選取縮圖或數
字鍵。
要使用數字鍵選取時,請輸入兩位數字,然後
按下 ENTER
按鍵 按鍵功能
可暫停幻燈片秀 (或音頻)的播
放;再按時可再度開始播放。
可跳至前一張圖片 (或音頻檔案
的音頻播放)
可跳至下一張圖片 (或音頻檔案
的音頻播放)
///
可暫停幻燈片秀的播放,並旋轉
/翻動所顯示的圖片 (按下
播放)按鍵可重新開始播放
幻燈片秀)
SHIFT+
ZOOM
可暫停幻燈片秀的播放,並將圖
片放大。再按時可切換一倍、二
倍及四倍的放大倍數 (按下
播放)按鍵可重新開始播放
幻燈片秀)
MENU
可顯示 「碟片導向」畫面
(請參閱以下說明)
Disc Navigator
Disc Navigator
Title
Chapter
01
04
02
05
03
06
Disc Navigator: Title
01- 49: - -
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 27 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
28
Zhtw
可利用 「碟片導向」功能瀏覽
Windows Media
TM
Audio
(WMA)MP3MPEG-4 AAC
DivX 視頻 /WMV JPEG 檔案
使用 「碟片導向」按照檔名尋找一特定的檔案
或資料夾。
1 按下 HOME MENU 並從在屏顯示選單中選
取「Disc Navigator (碟片導向)
2 使用 /// ENTER 來瀏覽。
使用 / 上下移動資料夾/檔案清單。
使用 回到根資料夾。
1
使用 ENTER 可開啟一反白的資料夾。
當反白
JPEG 便有一縮圖影像顯示在
螢幕右側。
3 要播放反白的曲目或 DivX 視頻 /WMV
案或顯示反白的 JPEG 時,可 ENTER
當已選取
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC
DivX 視頻 /WMV 檔案,則會自該檔案開
始播放到整個資料夾結束為止。
當選取了
JPEG 檔案,幻燈片秀即會開始,
並從所選檔案開始播放一直到整個資料夾
播放完為止。
提示
在聆聽
WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 的播
也可以同時播放
JPEG 燈片秀只需
選取想要聆聽的音頻檔再選取想要播放
幻燈片秀的
JPEG 案即可此時幻燈片秀
及音頻檔案會同時不斷重複播放各項播放
控制僅適用於
JPEG 幻燈片秀。
要播放整張碟片而不是只有目前資料夾的
容,請退出
Disc Navigator (碟
導向)然後使用 (播放)按鍵來開始
播放。
使用播放清單
配合此項功能,您可以將含有 WMAMP3
MPEG-4 AAC JPEG 檔案的碟片製作成三
份播放清單 (每份
30 個檔案)。由於本機會
記住最後十張置入碟片的所有播放清單,這在
您想要快速且輕鬆地整理大量的檔案時,相當
有用。
2
製作播放清單
1 在碟片停止時,按下 HOME MENU 從在
屏顯示選單中選取 Disc Navigator (碟片
)」。
2 選取想要加到播放清單上的檔案。
若不知道怎麼做,請參閱上述
可利用 「碟片導
向」功能瀏覽
Windows Media
TM
Audio
(WMA)
MP3
MPEG-4 AAC
DivX
視頻
/
WMV
JPEG
檔案
3 按下 PLAYLIST
1
2
3
此時檔案會加到所選取的播放清單上。
4 重複步驟 2 3直到整個操作完成。
附註
1 您也可以進入最上層的 ..」資料夾,然後按下 ENTER 來完成此項動作。
00:00/ 00:00 0kbps
Folder1
Folder2
Folder3
Folder4
File1
File2
File3
File4
File5
Folder2
00:00/ 00:00 0kbps
2 該碟片必須置入才能播放在播放清單當中的檔案。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 28 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
29
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
提示
要在沒有在屏顯示畫面的情況下加入檔案
只需在正常播放所需檔案期間按下
PLAYLIST
1
2
3
即可(除在播放音頻的
同時,又播放
JPEG 幻燈片秀外)
聆聽播放清單
播放停止時,按下 PLAYLIST 12 3
播放期間,前面板顯示幕中 PGM 指示燈會
起。若未設定任何播放清單,則顯示幕中會顯
NO LIST
若播放清單內含有
JPEG 音頻兩種檔案,
則會開始播放幻燈片秀及音頻檔案。
清除播放清單上的檔案
1 開始播放您的播放清單。
2 從「Disc Navigator 碟片導向)」畫面
反白想從播放清單上清除的檔案並按下
CLEAR
循環播放碟片某個片段
A-B 重複功能可讓您指定一曲目 CD
VCD/ 超級 VCD或一標題DVD中的兩點
A B,來一直不斷地循環播放。
1 播放期間按下HOME MENU並選取Play
Mode (播放模式)
2 選取 A-B Repeat A-B )」。
3 在「A(Start Point) 開始點)」上按下
ENTER 設置循環播放的開始點。
4 在「B(End Point) (結束點)」上按下
ENTER 以設置循環播放的結束點。
在按下 ENTER 後,播放作業會跳回至開始點
然後開始循環播放。
5 要恢復正常播放,請選取 Off )」。
使用重複播放功能
除了各種的重複播放選項外,也可以將重複播
放同程序播放一起使用 (請參閱第
30 頁的
立程序編輯清單
)。
1 播放期間按下HOME MENU並選Play
Mode (播放模式)
2 選取 Repeat (重複,然後選取重複
播放選項。
1
如果程序播放功能啟動,可選取 Program
Repeat (重複播放程式來重複播放程序編
輯清單,或選取 Repeat Off 關閉重複播
放)取消重複播放。
播放
DVD 碟片可選取 Title Repeat(重
複播放標題) Chapter Repeat重複播
放章)
播放
CD VCD/ 超級 VCD 可選取 Disc
Repeat(重複播放單碟) Track Repeat
(重複播放曲目)
播放 DivX 視頻 /WMV 碟片可選取 Title
Repeat重複播放標題)(或 Repeat Off
(關閉重複播放))。
使用隨機播放功能
可使用此項功能以隨意的順序來播放標題或章
節(
DVD-Video)或曲目 CD VCD/ 超級
VCD)。
2
1 播放期間按下HOME MENU並選取Play
Mode (播放模式)
Play Mode
附註
1 您無法使用重複播放功能播放 WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 碟片。
2 您可以在碟片播放或停止的同時,設置隨機播放的選項。然而,您無法將隨機播放搭配程序播放一起使用。
您不能使用隨機播放來播放 VR 格式 DVD-R/-RW 碟片、WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 碟片、DivX 視頻 /WMV 碟片,或在
DVD 碟片選單已顯示的情況下使用。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 29 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
30
Zhtw
2 選取 Random隨機)然後選取一個
選項。
播放
DVD 碟片時,可選取 Random Title
(隨機播放標題) Random Chapter(隨
機播放章)
播放
CD VCD/ 超級 VCD 可選取 On
(開) Off(關)以開啟或關閉隨機播放
功能。
提示
隨機播放期間使用以下控制功能
:
隨機播放會繼續執直到您從隨機播放選
單選項中選取了 Random Off (隨機播放
關閉)為止。
建立程序編輯清單
本項功能可讓您編輯碟片上標題/章節/曲目
的播放順序程序。
1
1 播放期間按下HOME MENU並選取Play
Mode (播放模式)
2 選取Program(程序編輯)然後從程
式選項清單中選取 Create/Edit (編序創建
)」。
3 使用 /// ENTER 以選取一標題
章節或曲目作為目前在節目清單中的步驟。
對於
DVD 碟片您還可以增加標題或是章
節。
對於
CD VCD/ 超級 VCD可選取曲目加
到程序編輯清單之中。
在按下 ENTER 選取標題/章節/曲目後編序
步驟編號會自動向下移動一位。
4 請重複步驟 3 以建立一編序列表。
一份編序列表中可包含多達
24 個編序步驟。
您只需將您想顯示新編序步驟的位置加以
反白再輸入標題/章節/曲目編號便可插
入編序步驟。
要刪除編序步驟請將其反白後按下CLEAR
即可。
5 要播放編序列表請按下 (播放)按鍵
程序編輯清單會繼續存在,直到您關閉程序播
請參閱以下說明)刪除程序編輯清單(請
參閱以下說明),退出碟片或關機為止。
提示
程序播放期間使用以下控制功能
:
程序編輯選單中其他可用的功能
在程序編輯選單中尚有除了編序創建/編輯以
外的其他選項。
Playback Start (編序播放開始)
可開
始播放儲存的程序編輯清單
Playback Stop (編序播放停止)
可關
閉程序播放,但不會刪除程序編輯清單
Program Delete(編序刪除)
可刪除程
序編輯清單並關閉程序播放
搜索碟片
您可以按標題或章節編號或按時間來搜索
DVD 碟片;CD VCD/ 超級 VCD 可按曲目
編號或時間;
DivX 視頻 /WMV 碟片則可按時
間來搜索。
按鍵 按鍵功能
隨機播放下選取一新的曲目/標
題/章節。
可返回至目前曲目/標題/章節
的開頭;再按時可隨機選取其他
的曲目/標題/章節。
附註
1VR格式的 DVD-R/-RW 碟片WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 碟片、DivX 視頻 /WMV 碟片或 DVD 碟片選單顯示時,無法使用
程序播放功能。
按鍵 按鍵功能
HOME
MENU
可儲存程序編輯清單並退出但不
播放。
可跳至程序編輯清單中的下一個
編序步驟。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 30 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
碟片播放功能
06
31
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
1 按下 HOME MENU 並選 Play Mode
(播放模式)
2 選取 Search Mode (搜索模式)
所呈現的搜索選項會視置入的碟片種類而定。
3 選取搜索模式。
碟片必須按序播放以便使用時間搜索功能
4 使用數字鍵輸入標題章節或曲目編號
時間。
使用時間搜索時請按照您想要恢復播放的
位置來輸入目前播放標題
DVD/DivX
/WMV或曲目CD/VCD/ 超級 VCD
的分鐘數及秒數。例如,按下 4500
即會從碟片上的第
45 分鐘位置開始播放。
想要輸入
1 小時、20 分鐘又 30 秒時,可
按下 8030
5 按下 ENTER 開始播放。
切換字幕
某些 DVD 碟片及 DivX 視頻碟片擁有一種以上
語言的字幕;在碟片包裝上會清楚告訴您可以
使用的字幕語言種類。您可以在播放期間來切
換字幕語言。
1
連續按下 SHIFT+SUBTITLE 選取一種字
幕選項。
要設置字幕的喜好設定參閱第
39 頁的
語言設定值
更多關於
DivX 字幕的資訊請參閱第 53
顯示
DivX
字幕檔案
切換對白語言/音頻聲道
在播放錄有兩種或更多語言對白內容,或錄有
雙單聲道音效的碟片時
2
可以在播放期間來
切換這些功能。
3
播放 VCD/ 超級 VCD 您可以切換立體聲
僅左聲道或僅右聲道。
連續按下SHIFT+AUDIO以選取一種對白語
言選項。
要設置對白語言的喜好設定,請參閱第
39
頁的
語言設定值
放大畫面
使用放大功能,您可以在觀賞 DVDDivX
/WMV 標題或 VCD/超級 VCD,或 JPEG
碟片時,將畫面某個部位放大二倍或四倍。
1 播放期間使用 SHIFT+ZOOM 按鍵以選取
放大的倍數 (正常、2 x 4 x )。
2 使用 /// 變更縮放區域。
您可以在播放期間自由切換放大倍數,以及放
大區域。
4
切換拍攝角度
某些DVD碟片錄有兩種或更多角度拍攝而成的
場景-請參閱碟片包裝上的詳細說明。
在播放多角度場景時屏幕上會出現 的圖示
(您也可以選取將它關閉-請參閱第
40頁的
示幕設定值
)。
播放期間(或暫停時),按 SHIFT+ANGLE
以切換角度。
顯示碟片資訊
播放期間,可將各種曲目、章節及標題的資訊
顯示在屏幕上。
要顯示/切換/隱藏顯示的資訊可連續按
DISPLAY
有限的碟片資訊亦會出現前面板的螢幕中。按
DISPLAY 以變更所顯示的資訊。
附註
1 某些碟片僅允許您從碟片選單中來改變字幕語言。按下 TOP MENU MENU 即可進入選單。
2 某些超級 VCD 錄有兩種音軌。在播放這些碟片時,您可以切換這兩種音軌,以及每個音軌獨有的聲道。
3 某些碟片僅允許您從碟片選單中來改變對白語言。按下 TOP MENU MENU 即可進入選單。
4 由於 DVDVCD/ 超級 VCDDivX 視頻 /WMV 標題及 JPEG 片只有固定的解析度,因此畫質特別在放大四倍時會有失
真的情形。這並不是故障。
如果畫面上方的導向方塊消失,可按下 SHIFT+ZOOM 再將它顯示在螢幕上。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 31 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
USB 播放與錄製
07
32
Zhtw
7
USB 播放與錄製
使用 USB 介面
利用本機前面的 USB面就可以聆聽雙聲道
1
並觀看 DivX 視頻 /WMV/JPEG 案。按
圖方式連接一
USB 量儲存裝置
2
1 開啟播放器後,按下 USB
確定電視機已開並設定為正確的視頻輸入。
2 連接您的 USB 裝置。
USB 端子的位置就在前面板上。
3 按下 (播放)以開始播放。
若是您的
USB 裝置當中含有 JPEG,則會開始
幻燈片秀與其相關的更多資訊請參閱第
26
頁的
播放
JPEG
幻燈片秀
確定在脫離時(或系統在待機狀態下),前
面板顯示幕上顯示 USB DATA
重要提示
若顯示幕中的 USB ERR 訊息指示燈亮起則表
示該
USB 裝置的電源需求對於本機來說太高,
或該裝置不相容。請嘗試以下方法:
關閉播放器,然後再開啟。
重新在播放器關閉時將
USB 裝置接上。
選取其他輸入來源(如 DVD/CD,然
頭選取 USB
使用原廠專用的
AC 電源變壓器(隨裝置附
贈)供應
USB 電源。
若上述方式無法解決問題,則應該是您的
USB
裝置不相容。
USB 裝置上錄製音樂 CD 的曲
在連接至 USB 埠的 USB 上可以錄製載入本機
中的音樂
CD 曲目。
錄製所有曲目
1 載入音樂 CD
按下 停止播放。
附註
1 這包括 DivX 視頻 /WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC 檔案 (除含防拷內容或限制播放內容的檔案外)的播放。
2 相容 USB 裝置包括屬於 FAT16/32 格式的磁碟機、可攜式快閃記憶體 (特殊隨身碟)及數位音頻播放器 MP3 播放
器)。本機不能連接至個人電腦上進行
USB 播放。
先鋒概不保證所有 USB 大量儲存裝置的相容性 操作及/或匯流排電源)亦不承擔連接至本機時可能造成資料遺失的
相關責任。
資料含量很大時,系統會需要較長的時間來讀取 USB 裝置的內容。
本機可能無法正確識別某些 USB 裝置。
即使是支援的格式,仍會因內容而無法播放或顯示某些檔案。
USB
USB
USB
USB τ໕
ᓾԇ၇ဋ
Ȟ
A
࠯ȟ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 32 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
USB 播放與錄製
07
33
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
2 按下 SHIFT+USB REC,顯 CD -> USB
Rec CD>USB 轉錄)」畫面。
3 按下 ENTER 開始錄製。
開始錄製。錄製時,顯示以下所示的畫面。
1
錄製特定曲目
1 載入音樂 CD
按下 停止播放。
2 HOME MENU,然後選擇 CD ->USB
Rec CD ->USB 轉錄
只有在停止播放音樂
CD 時,才能選擇 CD -
>USB Rec CD ->USB 轉錄
3 使用 /// ENTER 成各項設定
值。
4 選取您要錄製的曲目。
Individual 個別選取) 一次選取一個
曲目。
Select All (選擇全部) 選取所有曲目
All Clear (清除全部) 清除所選取的所
有曲目。
5 選擇位元率 (傳輸率)
選擇 128 kbps192 kbps 320 kbps
6 使用 /// 選擇 Start (開始),然
後按 ENTER
2
開始錄製。
附註
1 如果 USB 裝置沒有足夠的空間,則無法開始錄製。 在這種情況中,顯示 Available USB space is low (可用 USB 空間不
)」。
CD –> USB Rec
Select Track
Bitrate
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
128kbps
13
055:07
Track Progress
Total Progress
Selected Track
Total T im e
13
055:07
Cancel
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
CD – > USB Rec
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
00
000:00
Select Track
Bitrate
Individual
Select All
All Clear
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
2 完成錄製時, USB 裝置上會自動建立一個名為 PIONEER」的資料夾。所錄製的曲目儲存在此資料夾中。
最多可建立 99 個「PIONEER」資料夾。
如果 USB 裝置包含 300 或以上的資料夾,則無法進行錄製。
USB 裝置上進行錄製時,除了操作 STANDBY/ON OPEN/CLOSE 按鍵與切換功能外,停止所有與 DVD 相關的
主要操作。
睡眠定時器 ON (開啟)時,開始在 USB 裝置錄製後即將它取消開啟。
Start
Selected Track
Total Time
01
003:17
Select Track
Bitrate
Individual
Select All
All Clear
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
Start
Selected Track
Total Time
03
012:17
Select Track
Bitrate
128kbps
192kbps
320kbps
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
CD –> USB Rec
Select Track
Bitrate
Start
Selected Track
Total T im e
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
128kbps
03
012:17
Track Progress
Total Progress
Selected Track
Total T im e
03
012:17
Cancel
01:43
03:17
04:18
04:59
04:20
04:38
04:40
04:11
Track 1–13
Track01
Track02
Track03
Track04
Track05
Track06
Track07
Track08
CD –> USB Rec
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 33 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
卡拉 OK 伴唱
08
34
Zhtw
8
卡拉 OK 伴唱
卡拉 OK 伴唱
使用伴唱功能,您可以將麥克風插上後,將自
己的聲音溶入背景音樂當中
1
您可以選取來自
CDDVDVCD USB 裝置等音源的背景
樂。請調整麥克風與背景相對的音量。
1 插入麥克風。
如果只有使用一隻麥克風請將它插上 MIC
(MAIN) 插孔。MIC (SUB) 插孔只能在有接上
MIC (MAIN) 的情況下才能使用。
如果麥克風上有開關,請撥至開的位置。
2 置入有伴唱背景音樂的碟片。
您也可以利用
USB 裝置的曲目作為背景音樂的
來源媒體。
3 調整 KARAOKE 模式設定。
SHIFT+KARAOKE 可開啟或關閉碟片
(左右置聲道有人聲)的 KARAOKE 模式:
KARAOKE (人聲消音)-背景音樂中的人聲
有部分會消音。
OFF (預設值)-可將伴唱模式關閉。
SHIFT+AUDIO 可切換碟片(僅單聲道有
人聲曲目)音頻聲道(除資料碟片和 USB
源外)
Left僅左聲道。用於右聲道中錄製有人聲道
的曲目。
Right僅右聲道於左聲道中錄製有人聲道
的曲目。
STEREO可將伴唱模式關閉。
4 播放背景音樂。
5 調整 MIC VOL +/– 旋鈕至您想要的聲音
2
為避免產生惱人的回饋信號,請確定您沒有將
麥克風朝向揚聲器。
3
變更混聲效果
在麥克風混聲中加入一些效果有時可以改善整
體聲音的感覺。您可以選取三種迴音位準。
要在麥克風中加入效果,請按下
SHIFT+ECHO
連續按下以切換音量
1 到音量 3 及關。
變更背景音樂
您可能需要降低或提高背景音樂的音量以配合
您的聲音。
4
按下 SHIFT+ SHIFT+ 以降低或提高背
景音樂的音量高低。
附註
1 這些功能只有在接上麥克風時才可使用。如果您嘗試在未接上麥克風時使用 SHIFT+KARAOKESHIFT+ECHO
SHIFT+SHIFT+ MIC VOL,則螢幕會顯示 NO MIC (未接上麥克風)訊息。另請注意,在播放
DVD 的期間,當您接上
麥克風時,聲音設定自動切換成 STEREO 播放,並將多聲道來源縮混成
2.1 聲道。
這些功能只能搭配 DVD/CD USB 輸入功能使用。
MAIN SUB
MCACC SET UP
MIC
2MIC VOL在您取下麥克風,變更功能或關閉電源時設定為 0
3 視麥克風音量而定,碟片的聲音可能會失真。如果發生此種情形,請將音量調低。
4 此功能與 DTS 訊號不相容。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 34 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
環繞音效設定值
09
35
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
9
環繞音效設定值
運用音效設定選單
「音效設定」選單上,可存取系統的所有環
繞音效設定值包括聲道位準揚聲器間距
動態範圍
CD 類型及音場調整自動 MCACC
功能 (第 17 頁)應能帶給您最佳的環繞音效
設定。然而,您會發現藉由進一步調整環繞音
效設定值還能改善所在聆聽室內的環繞效果
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP 並使用 / 以選取
SOUNDSET然後按下 ENTER 選取想要調整的
設定值。
可使用的設定值如前面板顯示幕中所示。
1
2 使用 / 進行調整,然後按下 ENTER
認並退出。
注意再度使用自動
MCACC(第 17 頁)
覆蓋先前的揚聲器設定值。
「聲道位準」設定值 CH LEVEL
不適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機種
設置您主要聆聽位置的相對聲道音量。
2
使用 / 依下列順序切換聲道:
L左前置揚聲器
C中置揚聲器
R右前置揚聲器
SR右環繞揚聲器
SL左環繞揚聲器
SW重低音
聲道音量範圍為 ±10 dB
揚聲器間距設定值 DISTANCE
不適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機種
可指定您聆聽位置至您揚聲器的距離。
DISTANCE 出現在螢幕上按下 ENTER,然
後使用 / 調整間距,並按下
/ 切換下
列的揚聲器:
L左前置揚聲器
C中置揚聲器
R右前置揚聲器
SR右環繞揚聲器
SL左環繞揚聲器
SW重低音
各揚聲器可調整在 0.1 m 9.0 m 之間。預設
值為 3.0 m
動態範圍控制 D.R.C.
可指定 Dolby Digital 或一些 DTS 音效聲軌的
動態範圍調整值。若無法正確聽到低階音效或
對話的聲音,這可有助於提高低音效的音量,
並有效控制高階的音量。
OFF
(預設值)
無動態範圍調整 (以較
高音量聆聽時使用)
MID -適中設定值
HIGH 動態範圍縮減 (大聲音效音量降
低,而較靜音效音量增高
附註
1 閒置五分鐘後,設定選單會自動退出。
2 耳機接上時無法設定聲道位準值。
揚聲器音量可隨時按 VOLUME +/– 進行調整然後使用 / 調整聲道位準 在選取 TESTTONE 測試音會自動依上
述順序從一揚聲器移動至另一揚聲器。當坐在主要聆聽位置上,您應該會聽到來自每個揚聲器同樣音量的測試音調。在您完
成時,按下 ENTER
由於重低音會產生超低階頻率,因此聽起來會比實際上的音量安靜一些。
音量設定為 51 或以上時,您無法選擇 TESTTONE 且聲道音量設定範圍受到限制。 此外,如果任何揚聲器的聲道音量範圍
設定在 + 端,則最大音量也會受到限制。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 35 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
環繞音效設定值
09
36
Zhtw
DTS CD 設定值 CD TYPE
如果您在播放 DTS 編碼的 CD,您會需要變更
此項設定值才能聽到解碼後的訊號。
NORMAL一般
CD播放有些DTS編碼CD
在播放時會輸出雜訊。
DTS-CD進行
DTS編碼CD的正確解碼
CD 曲目的開頭可能會跳過。
「雙單聲道」設定值 DUALMONO
此設定值可律定雙單聲道如何解碼,Dolby
Digital
音效應該播放的方式。 此設定也可用
於變更以雙語音頻錄製
DVD-RW 碟片的聲
道,以及有雙語音頻的外部輸入。
1 連續按下 SHIFT+AUDIO 以選取設定。
碟片正在播放雙單道音頻時選取下列的設定
值。
1
CH1 MONO只有聲道 1 播放
CH2 MONO只有聲道
2 播放
CH1/CH2兩個聲道均經由前置揚聲器播
有效聲音用於取得最佳聲音 S.FIELD
本機隨附特殊形狀的高品質揚聲器,有效聲音
模式啟用下列針對電影和音樂的原音最佳真實
體驗的先鋒獨家音頻技術而設計。
在正常情況下,開啟有效聲音模式可最佳化本
機的功能。
2
動態範圍壓縮
重現容易遭受環境噪音影響的細部聲音會創造
出一個讓您感覺身歷其境的原音環境。
頻率特性修正
瞭解除了隨附的揚聲器裝置的新增功能外,針
對長時間聆聽而最佳化的播放特性。
EFFECT (有效聲音)播放特性已針對隨
附揚聲器最佳化的聲音
DIRECT(直接聲音)關閉有效聲音模式
附註
1 選取 DVD 功能時,所顯示的設定項目為 LR L+R (顯示在 OSD 上)
2 音場不會影響耳機輸出。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 36 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
「視頻調整」選單
10
37
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
10
「視頻調整」選單
「視頻調整」選單
「視頻調整」的功能畫面中,您可以調整能
影響影像呈現的設定值。
1 按下 HOME MENU 並從在屏顯示畫面選取
Video Adjust (視頻調整)
2 使用 /// ENTER 來完成設定值
您可以調整以下的設定值:
Sharpness(銳度)可調整畫面邊緣的銳
利度Fine(精細)Standard(標準)
Soft (柔和
Brightness(亮度調整整體呈現的亮
度(20 +20
Contrast (對比度)可調整亮與暗之間
的對比呈現 16 +16
Gamma (伽瑪)可調整影像的 「暖度」
High(高)Medium(中)Low(低)
Off (關)
Hue(色調)可調整紅/綠平衡(Green
9 綠色9) Red 9 紅色9)
Chroma Level(色度等級)
可調色彩呈
現的飽和度 9 +9
使用 / 來調整亮度、對比度、色調及色度
等級等設定值。
3 按下 ENTER 以返回 Video Adjust (視
調」功 面,或 HOME MENU 退
出功能畫面。
Video Adjust
Sharpness
Brightness
Contrast
Gamma
Hue
Chroma Level
Standard
0
0
Off
0
0
Video Adjust
Brightness min max 0
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 37 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
「初始設置」選單
11
38
Zhtw
11
「初始設置」選單
使用 「初始設置」選單
「初始設置」選單提供音頻及視頻輸出設定值
成人鎖定,以及顯示設定值等。
如果選項呈現淡出的灰色,則表示此時無法接
受變更。此種情形通常是因為碟片正在播放的
緣故。請停止碟片的播放,再變更設定值。
1 按下 DVD/CD
2 停止播放時,按下 HOME MENU 並選取
Initial Settings (初始設置)
3 使用 /// ENTER 選取想要設
定的設定值及選項。
所有設定值及選項將會在後續的內容中詳加說
明。
1
數位音頻輸出設置
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
視頻輸出設定值
附註
1 在表中,預設值會以粗體字顯示;其他的設定值則會以
斜體字
顯示在螢幕上。
某些設定值,像是 TV Screen (電視機屏幕Audio Language (對白語言) Subtitle Language (字幕語言可能
DVD 碟片並不具效用。通常這些設定值亦可從 DVD 的碟片選單中來完成設置。
HDMI Resolution HDMI 解析度) HDMI Color HDMI 色彩)設定值只有在您利用 HDMI 接頭將本播放器連接至
HDMI 相容設備時,才有必要進行設定。
2 當您經由 HDMI 連接方式、並將 HDMI 解析度設為 1920 x 1080p1920 x 1080i 1280 x 720p 時,才能使用此設定。
使用此設定值時,您只能使
HDMI 連接方式。
Initial Settings
設定值 選項 說明
Dolby Digital Out
(杜比數碼輸出)
Dolby Digital
(杜比數碼)
Dolby Digital DVD 碟片在播放時即會輸出 Dolby Digital
碼數位音頻。
Dolby Digital > PCM
Dolby Digital
音頻此時在輸出前會轉換 PCM 音頻。
DTS Out DTS 輸出)
DTS
DTS 碟片在播放時即會輸出 DTS 編碼數位音頻。(如果您的
擴大器/接收器與
DTS 音頻不相容,則會有雜音輸出。)
DTS > PCM
播放 DTS 碟片時無法輸出數位音頻。 DTS 音頻在輸出前會
先轉換成
PCM 音頻。
設定值 選項 說明
TV Screen (電視機屏
幕)(另請參閱第
55
畫面大小及碟片
。)
4:3 (Letter Box)
如果您使用的是傳統
4:3 電視機時,需設置此項。寬螢幕電
影在播放時,上下兩側會有黑色條邊。
4:3 (Pan & Scan)
如果您使用的是傳統
4:3 電視機時,需設置此項。寬螢幕電
影在播放時會裁掉左右兩側一部分,以利填滿整個螢幕。
16:9 (Wide)
如果您使用的是寬螢幕電視機時,需設置此項。
16:9 (Compressed)
如果您使用的是寬螢幕電視機時需設置此項播放
4:3 的內
容時,畫面其中一側將顯示黑色條邊。
2
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 38 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
「初始設置」選單
11
39
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
語言設定值
Component Out
(色差視頻輸出)
(另請參閱
43 頁的
使用色差視頻輸出連
接。)
Interlace (隔行掃描) 您的電視機若不適用於逐行掃描視頻時,需設置此項。
Progressive
(逐行掃描)
您的電視機如果適用於逐行掃描視頻時,需設置此項 (請參
閱您電視機操作手冊中的詳細說明)。再按一次 ENTER 確認
(或按下 RETURN 取消設置)
請注意,逐行掃描視頻僅可經由色差視頻插孔輸出。
HDMI Resolution
HDMI 解析度) *
(請參閱第
44 頁的
使用
HDMI
連接
。)
*
預設值會配合電視格
式(
PAL/NTSC
)改變。
1920 x 1080p
如果電視機支援 1920 x 1080 畫素逐行掃描,則請設定此項。
1920 x 1080i
如果電視機支援 1920 x 1080 畫素隔行掃描則請設定此項
1280 x 720p
如果電視機支援 1280 x 720 畫素逐行掃描,則請設定此項。
720 x 480p (NTSC)/
720 x 576p (PAL)
如果電視機支援
720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) 畫素逐
行掃描,請設定此項。
720 x 480i (NTSC)/
720 x 576i (PAL)
如果電視機支援 720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) 畫素隔
行掃描,請設定此項。
HDMI Color
HDMI 色彩) *
(請參閱第
44 頁的
使用
HDMI
連接
。)
*
預設值會視連接的設
備改變。
Full range RGB
(進階
RGB
色彩微弱時,可提供更亮麗的色彩及更深的黑色 (此預設值
適用於
HDMI 相容的 DVI 設備)
RGB
使用
Full Range RGB (進階 RGB」設定值時,若色彩太
過飽滿,請設定此項。
Component (色差) 可輸出
8-bit 的色差視頻格式 (此預設值適用於 HDMI 相容
設備)
設定值 選項 說明
Audio Language
(對白語言)
漢語 如果碟片上錄有漢語的音軌,即會播放。
同顯示的語言
如果選取了碟片上語言,即會播放。
Other Language
(其他語言)
選取所顯示以外的語言 (請參閱第 60 頁的
使用語言代碼清
)。
Subtitle Language
(字幕語言)
漢語 如果碟片上有漢語字幕,即會顯示
同顯示的語言
會顯示在碟片上選取的字幕語言。
Other Language
(其他語言)
選取所顯示以外的語言 (請參閱第 60 頁的
使用語言代碼清
)。
DVD Menu Language
DVD 菜單語言)
w/Subtitle Lang.
(字幕語言連動)
可能的話,
DVD 碟片選單會以和您所選字幕語言相同的語言
顯示。
同顯示的語言
可能的話,DVD 選單會以所選的語言顯示。
Other Language
(其他語言)
選取所顯示以外的語言 (請參閱第 60 頁的
使用語言代碼清
)。
Subtitle Display
(字幕顯示)
On (開) 字幕會按您所選的字幕語言顯示。
Off
(關)
在您播放 DVD 碟片時,字幕會依預設方式保持關閉的狀態。
設定值 選項 說明
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 39 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
「初始設置」選單
11
40
Zhtw
顯示幕設定值
選項設定值
成人鎖定
預設等級:Off (關);預設密碼:
;預
設國家/地區代碼:us (2119)
為了讓您可以控制不讓您的小孩使用您的DVD
播放器觀賞影片,某些 DVD-Video 碟片結合
有成人鎖定的分級功能。如果您的播放器設置
的等級較碟片為低,碟片便無法播放。
某些碟片也有支援國家/地區代碼功能。本機
無法播放這些碟片上的某些場景,視您設置的
國家/地區代碼而定。
登錄新密碼
請輸入密碼以變更成人鎖定等級或輸入國家/
地區代碼。
1
1 選取 Password (密碼)
2 使用數字鍵輸入四位數字密碼,然後按下
ENTER
更換密碼
要更改密碼,請先確認現有密碼,再輸入新的
密碼。
1 選取Password Change(更換密碼)
輸入現行的密碼,然後按下 ENTER
2 輸入新密碼並按下 ENTER
設置/改變成人鎖定
1 選取 Level Change (改變級別)
2 使用數字鍵輸入您的密碼,然後按下
ENTER
3 選取新的等級並按下 ENTER
連續按 以鎖定在更高的層次(更多碟片
需要使用密碼);按 以取消鎖定層次
您不能鎖在等級
1
設定值 選項 說明
OSD Language
(在屏顯示語言)
漢語 機的在屏顯示畫面是以漢語顯示。
同顯示的語言
在屏顯示畫面會按所選的語言顯示。
Angle Indicator
(角度指示燈)
On (開) 在播放
DVD 碟片上的多角度場景期間,螢幕上會顯示相機圖
示。
Off
(關)
不顯示多角度指示圖示。
設定值 選項 說明
Parental Lock
(成人鎖定)
請參閱下列
成人鎖定
DivX(R) VOD Display
請參閱
下列關於
DivX
®
VOD
內容
附註
1 並非所有種類的碟片都使用成人鎖定功能,而且亦無須輸入密碼才能播放。
如果您忘記密碼,您會需要將播放器重置才能登記新的密碼 (請參閱第 60 頁的
重新設置系統
)。
Video Output
Language
Display
Options
Parental Lock
DivX (R) VOD
Password
Level Change
Country Code
Initial Settings
11_Initial settings menu.fm Page 40 Thursday, April 23, 2009 5:23 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
「初始設置」選單
11
41
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
設置/變更國家/地區代碼
您可以從第 61 頁的
國家/地區代碼清單
當中
找到。
1 選取 Country Code (國家代碼),輸
入密碼,然後按下 ENTER
2 選取國家/地區代碼,然後按 ENTER
在此提供兩種設置的方法:
按字母代碼選取使用 / 以變更國家/
地區代碼。
按數字代碼選取:按下 ,然後使用數字
鍵輸入四位數字的國家/地區代碼。
在退出碟片後,新的國家/地區代碼便立即生
效。
關於
DivX
®
VOD
內容
為了讓 DivX VOD(隨選視頻)的內容能在本機
上播放您必須先向您的
DivX VOD 內容供應商
登錄本機的資料您可以藉由產生一組
DivX
VOD
登錄代碼,發送給您的供應商來完成登錄
作業。
1
重要提示
DivX VOD 內容 DRM (數位版權管理)
系統所保護這會限制只有一些特定已登
錄的裝置才能播放。
如果您在本機內置入一片未經授權使用
DivX VOD 內容的碟片,螢幕上即會顯
Authorization Error 授權錯誤)的訊
息,同時內容亦無法播放。
顯示您的 DivX VOD 登錄代碼
1 按下 HOME MENU 並選取 Initial
Settings (初始設置)
2 選取Options選項)然後是DivX
(R) VOD」。
3 選取 Display」。
螢幕上顯示您的八位數字登錄代碼。
請記下代碼,因為在向您的
DivX VOD 供應商
登錄時會需要用到。
播放 DivX
®
VOD 內容
某些 DivX VOD 內容僅能作一定時間的播放。
在您置入含有此種
DivX VOD 內容的碟片時,
剩餘播放次數便會顯示在螢幕上,然後您便可
以選取要播放碟片 因此可以用上其中一種剩
餘播放次數,或停止播放如果您置入的是
含有期限已過的
DivX VOD (例如內容
的剩餘播放次數是零則螢幕上便會顯示
Rental Expired (租期已過)的訊息。
如果您的
DivX VOD內容允許不限次數的播放
那您便可以將碟片置入本機,並播放您常看的
內容,螢幕上亦不會顯示任何訊息。
附註
1 重置本機 (請參閱第 60 頁的
重新設置系統
)不致使您失去您的登錄代碼。
Video Output
Language
Display
Options
Display
Initial Settings
Parental Lock
DivX (R) VOD
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 41 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
42
Zhtw
12
其他接線
重要提示
在本機後面板連接或變更接線方式時,請確實將電源關閉並從牆壁插座拔下電源線。
完成所有接線後,請將電源線連接至牆壁插座上。
AC IN
HDMI OUT
Y
P
B
P
R
VIDEO OUT
VIDEO(TV)
COMPONENT
VIDEO
A
N
T
E
N
N
A
FM
UNBAL 75 AM LOOP
ADAPTER PORT
ANALOG AUDIO IN
SPEAKERS (4 )
LINE 2
L
R
LR
FRONT
SUB
WOOFER
OPTICAL
LINE 1
DIGITAL AUDIO IN DIGITAL AUDIO OUT
5 m Վ 6 m
Վ
ӏᏱ኶՞ᒰΤ
ٿՍॲᓝᒰя
ٿՍॲᓝᒰя
ՎġHDMI
ᒰΤ
AV
௦ԞᏣ
௄኶՞
ᒰяȞӏᏱȟ
ՎՔৰᒰΤ
PAL
ഀ௦ᓟ
ࡊѵЉጤ
ࡊϲЉጤ
ȞΛౝஆ༰ਠ
ߝ឵ጤȟ
KURO LINK ࣻৡޠ
ӒᎣ҂८Ⴌຝ
ћԓᓄॲ৵๊
Ⴌຝᐡ
AM ᕘ࠯
Љጤ
Bluetooth
®
༉ᒰᏣ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 42 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
43
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
使用色差視頻輸出連接
如果您的電視機有色差視頻輸入,您可以使用
這些輸入取代標準視頻輸出以得到更好的畫
質。
1
關於接線圖,請參閱第 42 頁上 3
使用色差視頻連接線連接 COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT 至您電視機上的色差輸入組。
關於逐行掃描視頻
相較隔行掃描視頻,逐行掃描視頻更能有效的
加倍影像的掃描頻率,產生相當穩定,無跳動
的影像。逐行掃描視頻僅可透過色差視頻輸出
端子輸出。
本機與逐行掃描及高傳真電視機之相容性。
本機與逐行掃描視頻 Macro Vision
System Copy Guard
相容。
2
連接數位音源
本系統具有光纖數位輸入。使用這些端子可連
接外部設備像是您的數位電視
MD 或是 CD
錄放機。
關於接線圖,請參閱第
42 頁上的 1
連接 DIGITAL AUDIO IN (LINE1) 插孔至外
部播放設備的數位輸出上。
這些包括像是數位電視、
MD 播放器、數位衛
星,或電玩系統的數位設備
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
本系統具有光纖數位輸出用於提供環繞播放。
關於接線圖,請參閱第 42 頁上的 5
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT 插孔連接至多聲
AV 接收器的數位輸入。
連接類比音頻設備
您可使用 ANALOG AUDIO IN (LINE 2) 插孔連
接類比音頻設備,例如卡帶播放器。
關於接線圖,請參閱第 42 頁上的 2
連接 ANALOG AUDIO IN (LINE 2) 插孔至
外部播放設備的類比輸出上。
可使用
RCA 針頭型立體聲連接線來連接。
附註
1
色差視頻輸出可在隔行掃描及逐行掃描格式之間作切換。請參閱第
38
頁的
視頻輸出設定值
使用 HDMI 線連接播放器時,設備的影像輸出不可在 Interlace (隔行掃描) Progressive (逐行掃描)式之間切
換。
HDMI 解析度設為 720 x 480i (NTSC)/720 x 576i (PAL) 格式時,將自動選取 Interlace (隔行掃描)式。但在其他設定
中,則是自動選取 Progressive (逐行掃描)格式。
2 消費者應注意,並非所有的高傳真電視機均能與本產品完全相容,且可能導致畫面上出現人為造成的現象。 對於 525 逐行
掃描畫面問題,建議使用者可將連接端子切換至 標準解析度」輸出 (隔行掃描)來加以改善。如果發生電視機與本機在相
容性方面的問題,請與本公司的客服中心聯繫。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 43 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
44
Zhtw
使用 HDMI 連接
若配備 HDMI DVI (結合 HDCP的顯示器
或顯示裝置,可利用一般市面上的
HDMI 連接
線將它連接至本播放器,以提供高品質的數位
視頻。
1
關於接線圖,請參閱第 42 頁上 4
使用 HDMI 連接線將本播放器的 HDMI
OUT 連接端子連接至 HDMI 相容顯示器上的
HDMI 接端子。
連接線接頭的箭頭應朝下精確對準播放器
的接頭。
您也可以調整解析度及色彩等
HDMI 設定值。
欲了解與這些設定值相關的更多資訊,請參閱
38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
切換 HDMI 音頻設置
您可以選擇系統揚聲器或電視,透過 HDMI
DVD/CD USB 功能的聲音。 HDMI 音頻
設定為 TV 時,您無法使用本系統的多個聲音
功能。
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 以選取 HDMI SET,然後按
ENTER
3 使用 / 以選取 HDMI MODE,然後按
ENTER
4 使用 / 選取想要的設定值,然後按下
ENTER
AMP 從本系統輸出
DVD/CD 的聲音與
USB 功能訊號。
TV 從電視機或平面電視機出
DVD/CD
聲音與
USB 能訊號。
2
重新設定 HDMI 連接
若出現錯誤訊息 (顯示幕屏示 HDMI ERR)或
若畫面一片空白 (如在變更解析度後),則請
參閱第
58 的故障排除指南。若仍無法解決
問題,則請依下述步驟重新設定
HDMI 連接
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 選取 INITIAL然後按下 ENTER
3 使用 / 選取 HDMIINIT,然後按下
ENTER
4INIT OK閃爍時,按下 ENTER
系統會重新啟動且
HDMI 定值會自動重新設
回原廠預設值。欲了解與這些設定值相關的更
多資訊,請參閱第
38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
關於 HDMI
HDMI High Definition Multimedia
Interface
)可支援以單一數位連接線連接
DVD 播放器、DTV、機上盒及其他影音設備,
並同時提供視頻及音頻。
HDMI 的研發是為了
提供能將
HDCP High Bandwidth Digital
Content Protection
)與 DVI Digital Visual
Interface
)兩項技術合而為一的規格HDCP
是用來保護由 DVI 相容顯示器所傳輸及接收的
數位內容。
附註
1 HDMI 連接方式僅適用於與 DVI HDCP High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection)相容的 DVI 設備。若選取
連接至
DVI 接頭,則需使用另外的轉接頭 DVIHDMI)完成連接。然而,DVI 連接方式並不支援音頻信號。欲了解更多
關資訊,請洽當地音響經銷商。
視連接的設備而定,使用 DVI 連接可能導致信號傳輸不穩。
若改變連接至 HDMI 輸出的設備,也必須變更 HDMI 設定值以符合新的設備 (請參閱第 38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
完成此
項操作)
2
同樣可以使用電視機內建的揚聲器來聆聽自 DVD USB 裝置輸入的音訊。
HDMI
端子的音頻輸出僅適用於雙聲道線型
PCM
。此時,聽不到來自本機揚聲 (或耳機)的任何聲音。所有其他音 (包括 TUNER)從本機正常輸出。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 44 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
45
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
HDMI 擁有能支援標準、增強或高畫質視頻及
多聲道環繞聲音效標準的能力。
HDMI 的功能
包括:未壓縮數位視頻、每秒可達
5 GB 頻寬
(含
HDTV 號)、單一接頭 (取代數條接線
及接線),以及能在影音來源及
DTV 等影音設
備間進行通訊等。
HDMI
HDMI
標誌及
High-Definition
Multimedia Interface
均為
HDMI Licensing,
LLC
的商標或註冊商標。
連接外部天線
連接外部 AM 天線時,可使用 5 m 6 m
烯基金屬線並安裝於室內或室外。保留連接的
環型天線。限使用隨附的
AM 形天線。
連接外部
FM 天線時可使用 PAL 連接頭接上
一組
FM 天線
關於接線圖,請參閱第
42 頁上的 6
用於無線享受音樂的
Bluetooth
®
傳輸器
適用於
HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD-AP/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
機型:
無線音樂播放
Bluetooth 傳輸 (先鋒型號 AS-BT100)連
接至本機時,可使用搭載
Bluetooth 無線技術
行動電話、數位音樂播放器等)的產品來無
線聆聽音樂
1
此外使用市售的支援Bluetooth
無線技術的發射器可以聆聽未配備Bluetooth
無線技術的裝置上的音樂。AS-BT100 機型支
SCMS-T 內容保因此在配備 SCMS-T
Bluetooth無線技術的產品上也可以享受音樂
遙控器操作
本系統隨附的遙控器允許您播放和停止媒體,
以及執行其他操作。
2
附註
1 Bluetooth 無線技術啟用裝置可能須支援 A2DP 設定。
2
Bluetooth 無線技術啟用裝置可能須支 AVRCP 設定。
我們不保證使用遙控器可以操作 Bluetooth 無線技術啟用的裝置。
ॲ዆ၦਠ
Ґᐡ
Bluetooth
®
༉ᒰᏣ
ሎ௢Ꮳᐈձ
Bluetooth
ณጤ׭
೛ఃң
၇ဋȈ
՘୞Ⴌၘ
ณጤ׭
೛ఃң
၇ဋȈ
኶՞ॲ዆ክܺᏣ
၇ဋґପറ
ġġġġġġġġġġġġġณጤ
׭೛
኶՞ॲ዆
ክܺᏣ
+
ġġġġġġġġġġġġġॲଊ
ึৣᏣ
ȞҀ୶ȟ
Bluetooth
Bluetooth
Bluetooth
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 45 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
46
Zhtw
連接選購的 Bluetooth 傳輸器
1 將系統切換至待機狀態然後將 Bluetooth
傳輸器連接至位於後面板的 ADAPTER PORT
關於接線圖,請參閱第
42 頁上的 7
2 按下 STANDBY/ON
3 ADAPTER PORT然後切換到BT AUDIO
輸入模式。
1
配對 Bluetooth 傳輸器和 Bluetooth
無線技術裝置
在使用 Bluetooth 傳輸器開始播放 Bluetooth
無線技術內容之前,必須完成 配對」。第
次操作系統或任何時候清除配對資料時,請確
定執行配對。
「配對」是登錄 Bluetooth
線技術裝置以啟用
Bluetooth訊的必要步驟
2
如需詳細資料,另請參閱您 Bluetooth
線技術裝置的操作手冊
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP 以選取 BT SETUP,然
後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / 以選取 PAIRING,然後按下
ENTER
3 使用 /,從 0000/1234/8888 中選擇要
使用的 PIN 碼,然後按 ENTER
PAIRING 閃爍。
注意
您可以使用任一個
0000/1234/8888 PIN
碼。Bluetooth 無線技術裝置使用除本系統
使用的任何其他
PIN 碼。
4 開啟您要配對的 Bluetooth 無線技術裝
置,將它放在靠近系統的位置,並設定在配對
模式。
5 檢查 Bluetooth 無線裝置是否偵測到
Bluetooth 傳輸器。
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置偵測到 Bluetooth
傳輸器時輸器的識別編號 AS-BT100
顯示在
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置清單中。
3
6 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置清單中,選取
Bluetooth 傳輸器,然後在步驟 3 輸入所選取
PIN 碼。
4
使用您的系統聆聽 Bluetooth 無線技
術裝置的音樂內容
1 ADAPTER PORT然後切換到 BT AUDIO
輸入模式。
2 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置連接至
Bluetooth 傳輸器。
附註
1 Bluetooth 傳輸器尚未插入 ADAPTER PORT 時,即使按下 ADAPTER PORT 也無法進入 BT AUDIO 輸入模式。
2 第一次使用 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置和 Bluetooth 傳輸器時,需要配對。
若要啟用 Bluetooth 通訊,您的系統和 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置都應該完成配對。
3 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置未顯示在偵測到的裝置清單中或未顯示時,則不會顯示 Bluetooth 線技術裝置清單。在有些
情況中,您可以使用配對模式來配對
Bluetooth 傳輸器和該 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置。
4
有些情況的 PIN 碼也稱為 「通行碼」
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 46 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他接線
12
47
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
連接
Bluetooth
無線技術裝置時:
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置名稱顯示在系統顯示
幕中。
1
未連接
Bluetooth
無線技術裝置時:
NODEVICE 顯示在系統顯示幕中。
3 開始播放儲存在 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置
中的音樂內容。
使用系統頂端和遙控器上的按鍵
Bluetooth
無線技術裝置進行下列操作
2
清除配對
3
1 請按 SHIFT+SETUP,選 BT SETUP,然
後按 ENTER
2 使用 / 以選取 PAIR CLR,然後按下
ENTER
3 顯示 CLR OK 時,請按 ENTER
Bluetooth
®
字標和商標為 Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
所有,先鋒公司使用這些標誌皆需獲得授權
其他商標和商品名稱分屬其各自的擁有者所
有。
附註
1 系統只能顯示英數字元。其他字元可能無法正確顯示。
2 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置應與 AVRCP 設定相容。
視您使用的 Bluetooth 線技術裝置而定,操作可能與此表所示有所不同。
按鍵 按鍵功能
/ (系統) 開始正常播放和暫停/取消
暫停播放。
(遙控器)
開始正常播放。
(遙控器)
暫停播放。
(系統/
遙控器)
停止播放。
(遙控器)
按下可開始向後快轉。
(遙控器)
按下可開始向前快轉。
(遙控器)
可跳至目前播放檔案的最前
面位置,再跳至前一個檔案。
(遙控器)
可跳至下一個檔案。
3 中斷連接 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置即可完成清除。
當您在清除後重新連接 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置時,請參閱第 46
的配對
Bluetooth
傳輸器和
Bluetooth
無線技術裝置
來重複配對步驟。
12_Other connections.fm Page 47 Thursday, April 23, 2009 4:44 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KURO LINK13
48
Zhtw
13
KURO LINK
使用 HDMI 連接線將本機連接至 KURO LINK
相容先鋒平面電視後,您可以使用所連接平面
電視的遙控器控制本機,並且讓所連接的平面
電視自動切換輸入,以回應本機執行的操作。
此外,從連接的平面電視輸入語言資訊時,本
機的圖形使用者介面顯示語言自動切換 (僅在
停止播放或圖形使用者介面的畫面未顯示,只
能使用
DVD/CD 功能時
如需有關透過
HDMI 接線可執行哪些操作的
詳細資訊,請參閱平面電視的操作手冊。
您無法搭配不支援
KURO LINK
的設備來使
用此功能。
我們不保證本機能搭配先鋒以外所製造的
KURO LINK
相容設備使用。
連接 KURO LINK
您可以同步操作所連接的平面電視。
確定將平面電視的音頻線連接至本機的音頻輸
入插孔。
關於接線圖,請參閱第
42 頁上 4
如果不使用高速
HDMI連接線KURO LINK
可能無法正常運作。
將平面電視直接連接至本機中斷與其他擴
大器或影音轉換器 (例如
HDMI 開關)的
直接連接會導致操作發生錯誤。
重要提示
在連接本系統或變更接線方式時請確實將
電源關閉並從牆壁插座拔下電源線完成所
有接線後請將電源線連接至牆壁插座
KURO LINK 設定
為了充份運用 KURO LINK 功能,您必須調整
本機的設定及
KURO LINK 相容的連接設備
需詳細資訊,請參閱每個設備的操作手冊。
MAIN
USB
SUBMIC
PHONES
HDMI
ഀ௦ጤ
HDMI
ഀ௦ጤ
HDMI
ᒰΤ
HDMI
ᒰя
HDMI
ᒰΤ
HDMI OUT
ڐуᘘτᏣ
ܗኈॲᙾඳᏣ
Ґᐡ
KURO LINK ࣻৡޠ
ӒᎣ҂८Ⴌຝ
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 48 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KURO LINK 13
49
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
設定 KURO LINK 模式
選取是否將本機的 KURO LINK 功能設定為 ON
OFF
您必須將它設定為 LINK ON 才能使用
KURO LINK 功能。
使用不支援
KURO LINK 功能的電視時
將此設定為
LINK OFF
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 以選取 HDMI SET,然後按下
ENTER
3 使用 / 以選取 KURO LINK然後按下
ENTER
4 使用 / 以選取設定值,再按下 ENTER
確認。
LINK ON -啟用
KURO LINK 功能。
LINK OFF -已停用
KURO LINK 無法使用
同步化操作。
使用同步化之前
一完成所有連接與設定後,您必須:
1 讓所有設備進入待機模式。
2 開啟所有設備的電源最後才開啟平面電視
的電源。
3 選擇 DVD/CD,並查看畫面上的視訊輸出
顯示是否正常。
同步化擴大模式
使用 KURO LINK 相容電視的遙控器可以設定
同步放大模式。
有關同步放大模式的從電視的
選單畫面中可以設定這些功能。
從電視的選單畫面中可以設定這些功能。
如需
詳細資訊,請參閱
KURO LINK 相容電視的操
作手冊。
同步化擴大模式操作
使用同步放大模式時連接至本機的 KURO
LINK
相容設備如下所述同步運作。
使用電視的遙控器可以設定本機音量及將
聲音靜音。
電視的電源設定為待機時,本機的電源也
會設定為待機
(本機正在播放視訊 DVD
關閉電視的電源也會自動關閉本機的
電源。
但有些情況中,本機電源無法自動
關閉例如當您正在聆聽
CD 或廣播並關
閉輸出裝置時。)
本機輸入在切換電視頻道時自動切換。
即使本機輸入切換至
DVD/CD以外的功能
同步放大模式仍然有效。
在先鋒 KURO LINK 相容平面電視上也可以使
用以下的操作。
調整本機音量或聲音靜音音量狀態會顯
示在平面電視的畫面上。
在平面電視上切換
OSD 語言時本機的語
言設定也會隨著切換。
取消同步化擴大模式
取消同步放大模式時,如果您正在觀看電
視上的電視節目,則本機電源會關閉。
在同步放大模式時本機電源若關閉
步放大模式會取消
若要重新開啟同步放
大模式請使用電視的遙控器選取同步放大
模式。
在同步放大模式時如果從電視選單畫面執
行從電視產生聲音的操作則會取消同步放
大模式。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 49 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
50
Zhtw
14
其他資訊
選項系統設定值
請參閱每節中的附註說明,了解與設定值相關
的更多資訊。每個部分的第一項設定值皆為預
設值。
1 按下 SHIFT+SETUP 使用 / 以選取 SYS
SET,然後按下 ENTER
2 使用 / ENTER 以選取您要調整的設
定值。
可使用的設定值如前面板顯示幕中所示。
1
3 使用 / 進行調整,然後按下 ENTER
認並退出。
調暗顯示幕亮度
您可以調整前面板顯示幕文字的亮度。
LIGHT較亮設定值
DARK較暗設定值
按鍵鎖設置
LOCK ON可令前面板按鍵及控制無法操
作。
LOCK OFF可恢復前面板按鍵及控制的一
般使用。
頻率間距設置
不適用於沙烏地阿拉伯、以色列、南非或其他
中東國家與免稅機型
如果您發現您無法成功調選到電台,則表示頻
率間距可能不適用您所在的國家/地區。
AM 9K
AM 10K
電視系統設置
本系統的預設值為 AUTO,除非您在播放部分
碟片時注意到影像有失真現象,否則請將其設
置為
AUTO。如果您發現在播放某些碟片時畫
面出現失真的情形,請將電視系統設置成符合
您所在國家或地區的系統。不過,這樣一來可
能會限制您可以觀看的碟片種類。請參閱下列
對照表,以了解各種碟片所適用的設定值
AUTOPAL
NTSC)。
2
在使 / 以選取 TV SYS(如上述之步
3)後,請按下 ENTER,將電視機系統變更
成以下的設定值:
AUTO
NTSC
NTSC
PAL
PAL
AUTO
CHANGE 閃爍時,請按 ENTER
系統將自動進入待機模式,然後再重新開啟電
源。
看到 POWER ON 後,您將在顯示幕上看
到新的電視系統設定。
附註
1 閒置五分鐘後,設定選單會自動退出。
2 多數新型的 PAL 電視機系統可偵測 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz (NTSC),並可自動切換垂直振幅,以消除顯示畫面中的垂直收縮現
象。
不過,有些情況是影像中呈現不出色彩。如果您的 PAL TV 沒有 V-Hold 控制功能,便會因為 NTSC 碟片中畫面搖晃而無
法觀看。如果電視機有
V-Hold 控制功能,請動手調整直到畫面停止滾動為止。部分電視機上,畫面會有垂直收縮的現象,
使螢幕上下兩側留有黑色條邊。
播放器設定值
媒體類型
系統格式
NTSC PAL AUTO
DVD/ 超級 VCD/
VCD/DivX 視頻 /
WMV
NTSC
NTSC PAL NTSC
PAL
NTSC PAL PAL
CD/MP3/WMV/
MPEG-4 AAC/
JPEG/ 無碟片
NTSC PAL
NTSC
PAL
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 50 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
51
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
設置睡眠定時器
睡眠定時器可在您睡著約一小時後將系統關
機,您完全無須擔心。
1
連續按 SHIFT+SLEEP 選取選項。
選取下列選項:
SLP ON約在一小時後關機。 指示燈
亮起。
SLP OFF取消睡眠定時器。
在選取 SLP ON 您可以再按下 SHIFT+SLEEP
以確認一下剩餘的時間。每條線代表約
12
剩餘時間)
碟片/內容格式播放相容性
本機適合播放各種類型 (媒體)及格式的碟片
可播放的碟片一般在碟片及/或碟片包裝上
有下列其中一種標誌然而請注意有些類型的碟
片,像是可燒錄式
CD
DVD
,可能仍屬於不
可播放的格式。
更多資訊,請參閱下列
碟片相容性參照表
本機可播放
DVD+R/+RW 碟片
FUJIFILM Corporation
的商標。
DVD Format/Logo Licensing
Corporation
的商標。
本機亦與 KODAK Picture CD 相容。
本播放器可支援能產生優異畫質、雙聲道的
IEC 的超級 VCD 並可支援寬屏幕畫面
關於 DualDisc 的播放
DualDisc 是一種全新、雙面的碟片,一面可
容納
DVD 格式的影像、聲音等,另一面則可
容納非
DVD 格式的內容如數位音頻媒體內
容。
而此種碟片容納非
DVD 音頻的一面因不符
CD-Audio 的規格,故可能會無法播放。
DualDiscDVD面可在本產品中播放DVD-
Audio
內容不能播放。
有關
DualDisc 規格的更多詳盡資訊,請洽詢
碟片製造商或碟片零售商。
碟片相容性參照表
附註
1 顯示幕在睡眠定時設置好時會變暗。
SLP --- --
DVD-Video DVD-R DVD-RW
VCD
Fujicolor CD
ॲᓝ
CD CD-R CD-RW
媒體 相容格式
CD-R/-RW
CD-AudioVCD/ 超級 VCDISO
9660 CD-ROM*
包含 MP3
WMAMPEG-4 AACJPEG
DivX 視頻 /WMV 檔案。
*
符合
ISO 9660 Level 1
2
之標
準。
CD
實體格式:
Mode1
Mode2 XA Form1
。與
Romeo
Joliet
兩種檔案系統相容。
多區段播放:否
未最終化碟片播放:否
Super Video CD (
ົ઼
VCD)
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 51 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
52
Zhtw
關於 DVD+R/DVD+RW 相容性
僅可播放以「視頻模式DVD-Video 模式)
錄製並已完成封片的
DVD+R/DVD+RW。然
而,有些在錄影期間所完成的編輯內容可能會
無法精確地播放。
關於 DivX
DivX DivX, Inc. 發明的數位音訊格式 本播
放器可以播放錄製在
DVDCD USB 儲存裝
置中的
DivX 視訊。
保有與
DVD-Video 相同的術語,獨特 DivX
視頻檔案均稱作 「標題」
DivX 視頻相容性
播放 DivX
®
視訊
1
副檔名.avi .divx(必須使用這些副檔名
以利本機辨識
DivX 視頻檔案
意,所
有採用
.avi
副檔名的檔案均會辨識成
MPEG4
但所有這些檔案並非一定是
DivX
視頻檔案亦因此不見得能在本機上播放
DVD-R/-RW
DVD-Video (視頻模式)、視頻
錄製
VR
*
UDF Bridge DVD-ROM
包含
MP3WMAMPEG-4 AACJPEG
DivX 視頻 /WMV 檔案。
*
編輯點可能無法完全按照編輯的方
式播放播放到編輯點時畫面可能會有
短暫空白的情形。
多重邊界播放:否
未最終化播放:否
PC
製作碟片
使用 PC 錄製的碟片可能會因為用
以製作碟片的軟體本身的設置而無
法播放。此時,請檢查
DVD-R/-RW
CD-R/-RW 軟體手冊或碟片包裝
上更多關於相容性的說明。
以封包燒錄方式錄製的碟片不相
容。
音頻壓縮
MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3)
Windows Media Audio (WMA)
MPEG-4 AAC
取樣頻率 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/48 kHz
位元率:任何傳輸率 (建議採用
128 kbps 以上)
VBR (可變位元率) MP3/WMA/
MPEG-4 AAC
播放:否
WMA 無失真編碼:否
DRM 數位版權管理相容性
容(受
DRM 保護之音樂檔案將
無法
本機上播放。)
副檔名.mp3.wma.m4a
(需
使用這些副檔名以利播放器辨識
MP3/
WMA/MPEG-4 AAC
檔案)
檔案結構 (可能有所不同):一張碟
片上最多可儲存 299 個資料夾每個資
料夾中最多可存放 648 資料夾及檔案
(合併後)
媒體 相容格式
JPEG
檔案
Baseline JPEGEXIF 2.2*靜態影
像檔案可達
3072 x 2048 解析度畫
*
為數位相機專用之檔案格式
逐行掃描 JPEG 相容性:否
副檔名:.jpg (必須使用這些副
檔名,以利本機辨識
JPEG 檔案)
檔案結構 (可能有所不同):一
張碟片上最多可儲存
299 個資料
夾;每個資料夾中最多可存放
648
資料夾及檔案 (合併後)
附註
1 無法播放容量大於 4 GB .avi 視頻檔案。
媒體 相容格式
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 52 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
53
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
顯示 DivX 字幕檔案
以下所列為 DivX 外部字幕檔案所適用的字型
您可以藉由設定能符合字幕檔案的Subtitle
Language (字幕語言)(在第
39 頁的
語言設
定值
,於螢幕上見到正確的字型組合。
1
小組 1 Albanian ( 阿爾巴尼亞語 ) (sq)Basque (
斯克語
) (eu)Catalan ( 嘉泰羅尼亞語 ) (ca)Danish
(
丹麥語 ) (da)Dutch ( 荷蘭語 ) (nl)English ( 英語 )
(en)
Faroese ( 法羅語 ) (fo)Finnish ( 芬蘭語 ) (fi)
French ( 法語 ) (fr)German ( 德語 ) (de)Icelandic
(
冰島語 ) (is)Irish ( 愛爾蘭語 ) (ga)Italian ( 義大利語
) (it)Norwegian ( 挪威語 ) (no)Portuguese ( 葡萄牙
) (pt)Rhaeto-Romanic ( 里托羅曼斯語 ) (rm)
Scottish ( 蘇格蘭語 ) (gd)Spanish ( 西班牙語 ) (es)
Swedish ( 瑞典語 ) (sv)
小組 2 Albanian ( 阿爾巴尼亞語 ) (sq)Croatian (
羅埃西亞語
) (hr)Czech ( 捷克語 ) (cs)Hungarian
(
匈牙利語 ) (hu)Polish ( 波蘭語 ) (pl)Romanian (
馬尼亞語
) (ro)Slovak ( 斯洛伐克語 ) (sk)Slovenian
(
斯洛維尼亞語 ) (sl)
小組 3 Bulgarian ( 保加利亞語 ) (bg)Byelorussian
(
白俄羅斯語 ) (be)Macedonian ( 馬其頓語 ) (mk)
Russian ( 俄語 ) (ru)Serbian ( 塞爾維亞語 ) (sr)
Ukrainian ( 烏克蘭語 ) (uk)
小組 4 Hebrew ( 希伯來 ) (iw)Yiddish ( 意第緒 ) (ji)
小組 5 Turkish ( 土耳其語 ) (tr)
DivX
®
DivX, Inc.
的註冊商標,並獲授權使
用。
關於 WMV
WMV Windows Media Video 的縮寫,且
Microsoft Corporation 所研發出來的視頻
壓縮技術。可使用
Windows Media Encoder
WMV 內容加以編碼。
本播放器可播放使用
Windows Media
Encoder 9 Series
編碼、使用 .wmv 副檔
名的
WMV9 檔案。
可使用
720 x 576畫素/720 x 480畫素以下
的大小。
不支援
Advanced Profile
DRM保護之視頻檔案將無法在本機上播
放。
檔案副檔名
.wmv
可使用
192 kbps 以下的位元率。
關於 MPEG-4 AAC
AAC (Advanced Audio Coding) MPEG-4
AAC
標準的核心技術主要結合 MPEG-2
AAC
是構成 MPEG-4 音頻壓縮技術的基礎
所使用的檔案格式及副檔名需視用以進行
AAC 檔案編碼的應用程式而定 本機可播放由
iTunes
®
所編碼,副檔名為 .m4a」的 AAC
檔案 DRM 所保護的檔案不能播放以及由某
iTunes
®
本所編碼的檔案也可能無法播
放,或檔名可能無法正確顯示。
Apple
iTunes
均是
Apple Inc.
於美國及其
他國家註冊的商標。
關於 WMA
本播放器可播放 Windows Media Audio 的內
容。
WMA Windows Media Audio 寫,且
Microsoft Corporation 所研發出來的音頻
壓縮技術。
WMA 內容可應 Windows
Media Player version 7.7.1
Windows
Media
Player 用于 Windows XP,或
Windows Media Player 9 Series 等軟體進行
編碼。
Windows Media
Microsoft Corporation
商標。
本產品採用
Microsoft Corporation
開發之技
術,未獲
Microsoft Licensing, Inc.
授權不得
使用或散布本技術。
附註
1 在外部字幕檔案部分,本機可支援以下的字幕格式檔案名稱 (請注意,這些檔案不會在碟片導向選單中顯示).srt
.sub.ssa.smi
某些外部字幕檔案可能無法正確顯示或完全無法顯示。
影片檔案的檔名必須重複出現在外部字幕檔案檔名的開頭處。
同一影片檔案能夠切換的外部字幕檔案數量,最多限定 10
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 53 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
54
Zhtw
碟片的使用及維護
手拿碟片時
拿取碟片時,請握住其邊緣以免在碟片任何一
面留下指紋、灰塵或刮痕。已經損壞或髒污的
碟片會影響播放的效能
如果碟片上留有指紋、灰塵等不潔物,請使用
柔軟、乾燥的布料擦拭乾淨。
請直向輕輕由碟片中央向外擦拭。請勿以畫圓
的方式擦拭碟片的表面
如有必要,請用拭布沾上酒精,或市面所購買
CD/DVD 清潔工具來更徹底清潔碟片
使用揮發劑、稀釋劑或其他設計用來清潔黑膠
唱片的清潔劑。
儲放碟片時
避免將碟片留在太冷、太濕或太熱 (包括受到
陽光直射)的環境中。不要將紙張或貼紙黏在
碟片上,或用鉛筆、鋼珠筆或其他尖銳的書寫
用具在上面書寫。這樣會損壞碟片。
碟片應避免事項
碟片係以高速在本機內旋轉。如果碟片發生爆
裂、碎裂、扭曲或其他損壞情形,請勿冒險置
於本機中播放-最終您可能會使本機損壞。
本機在設計上為僅可使用傳統、全圓的碟片。
先鋒聲明:對於因使用變形的碟片所引起的所
有責任,概不負責。
DVD Video 適用地區
所有的 DVD Video 碟片上均有印上地區標示
以指出該碟片於全球適用的地區您的
DVD
統亦有一地區標示 (就在背面板上)。來自不
相容地區的碟片將無法在本機上播放。在此情
況下,螢幕上會出現下列訊息:
Incompatible disc region number
(非兼容碟片區域碼)
Can’t play disc (無法播放碟片)
標示 ALL 的碟片可在任何的播放器上播放。
安裝及保養
安裝提示
本公司希望您未來幾年內都能盡情的享用本系
統,因此在選取安裝部位時,敬請牢記以下各
點:
務必 ...
在通風良好的室內使用。
置於平坦、水平的表面,像書桌、擱架或音響架
切勿 ...
在高溫或極濕的地點使用,包括暖爐或其他會產
生高熱的設備附近。
置於窗檯或其他會使系統受到陽光直射的地點。
在多灰或極濕的環境中使用。
直接擺在擴大器或音響系統裡使用時會逐漸變
熱的其他元件上。
在電視機或顯示器附近使用,因為有可能會產生
干擾特別是如果電視機有使用室內天線時。
在廚房或其他會使系統暴露在濃煙或蒸氣之中
的地點。
在厚毛毯或地毯上使用,或覆蓋布料這樣可
能會妨礙系統主機的正確散熱效果。
置於不平穩的表面,或面積不足以支撐系統主機
四腳的表面上。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 54 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
55
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
清潔讀寫頭時
DVD 播放器的讀寫頭一般使用是不會弄髒的,
但如因某些原因積灰或髒污時,請洽詢您所在
地的先鋒授權服務中心。雖然讀取頭清潔劑一
般市面上都可買得到,但本公司不建議使用以
免可能造成讀取頭損壞。
水氣凝結問題
如果將本機由溫暖的室內搬到室外,或室內溫
度遽然上升時,內部便可能會有水氣凝結。雖
然凝結的水氣不會對本機造成損壞,但可能會
使效能短時間內受到影響。請讓其有大約一小
時的時間恢復至較暖熱的溫度,再行開機。
搬動系統主機
如果您有必要移動到主機,且播放器內有碟
片,請先將其取出,然後按下前面板上的
STANDBY/ON 將系統關機。等到螢幕上的
-OFF- (關字樣消失後,再將電源插頭拔
下。
1
絕不可在播放期間將主機舉起或搬動
可能會使高速旋轉下的碟片損壞。
畫面大小及碟片格式
DVD-Video 碟片能收錄各種的畫面比例範例
從一般為
4:3 的電視節目到畫面比例高達 7:3
CinemaScope 寬螢幕電影
2
都可以。
電視機也有各種不同的畫面比例標準」的
4:3 以及寬屏幕 16:9
3
寬螢幕電視使用者
如果使用寬螢幕電視則本播放器的TV Screen
(電視機屏幕)設定應設為 16:9 (Wide) 16:9
(Compressed) (第
40 頁)
當您使用 16:9 (Wide) 設定觀賞以
4:3 格式所
錄製的碟片,您可以使用電視控制功能來選取
影像呈現的方式。您的電視機可能會不同的縮
放及伸展功能;細節部分請參閱您電視機所附
的操作手冊。
請注意部分電影的畫面比例大於
16:9,因
即便使用寬螢幕電視觀賞仍會以
Letter
Box
」樣式播放該種碟片 螢幕上下兩側出現
黑色條邊)
標準電視使用者
如果使用標準電視,則本播放器的 TV Screen
電視機屏幕設定可依您的喜好設為 4:3
(Letter Box) 4:3 (Pan & Scan)(第
38 頁)
請注意多數寬螢幕碟片會無視播放器的設定
因此無論設定為何碟片皆會以
Letter Box
格式顯示。
附註
1 如在 -OFF- (關)字樣自螢幕上消失前便將主機插頭拔掉,可能會使系統恢復成原廠的設置。
2 許多寬螢幕碟片都會無視系統的設定值,因此不管設定值為何,碟片都會 Letterbox」的格式顯示。
3 如果在標準 4:3 的電視機上採用 16:9 (Wide) 16:9 (Compressed) 的設定值,或寬螢幕電視機採用任何一種 4:3 設定值,
便會導致畫面失真。
設置成 4:3 (Letter Box) 時,寬螢
碟片在顯示畫面時,上下都會出現
黑色條邊。
設置成 4:3 (Pan & Scan) 時,寬螢
幕碟片在顯示畫面時,左右邊會有
截短的情形。雖然畫面看起來大
些,但您看到的不是實際的整個畫
面。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 55 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
56
Zhtw
故障排除
人們經常錯將不正確之操作當成系統故障或異常。如果您認為本機有任何問題,請按照以下各點
進行檢查。有時問題可能是來自其他裝置。請仔細檢查其他使用中的裝置和電器設備。如果在查
證過以下各點後問題還是無法改善請就近洽詢您的先鋒授權服務中心或經銷商前來代為維修
如果本系統是因為受到靜電等外來效應致使無法正常操作,請將電源插頭從輸出插座上拔下
再插回去,以回復正常的操作狀態。
關於音頻相關問題另請檢查音頻播放裝置的設定如需詳細資訊請參閱裝置的操作手冊
一般問題
問題 解決辦法
電源沒有打開,或突然
關機 (啟動時可能會
有一錯誤訊息顯示)
重開機前請等待一分鐘。
確定主機上的線束無鬆脫的情形。如有鬆脫,可能會造成系統自動關機。
檢查揚聲器連接是否正確
確定主電源的電壓確實適用於本型機種。
嘗試降低音量。
如果問題仍然存在,請將本機攜至最近的先鋒授權服務中心或您的經銷商
處接受維修。
選取功能後,沒有聲音
輸出。
如果您正使用線路輸入請確定設備連接是否正確(請參閱第 43 頁的
使用
色差視頻輸出連接
)。
如果 HDMI 音訊模式設定為 TV,則不會從連接至本機的揚聲器上輸出任何
聲音 (第
44 頁)
按下遙控器上的 MUTE 以關閉靜音功能。
調高音量。
沒有聲音來自環繞聲或
中置揚聲器。
請參閱第 35 頁的
「聲道位準」設定值
CH LEVEL
檢查揚聲器位準。
確定您並未選取 STEREO A.L.C的音效模式(請參閱第 22頁的
聆聽您的系
)。
正確連接揚聲器 (請參閱第 11 頁的
基本接線方式
)。
若來源是 96 kHz,則會以立體聲播放。
確認用於光纖數位連接線連接的外部設備的音頻輸出設定。
無法操作遙控器。
更新電池 (請參閱第 16 頁的
安裝遙控器電池
)。
請在遙控感應器的 7 m30°範圍內操作 (請參閱第 16 頁的
運用遙控
)。
移除障礙物或從其他位置操作。
避免前面板上的遙控感應器受到陽光直射。
麥克風的聲音聽不到。
您只能使用一隻麥克風並須將其插入 MIC (SUB) 插孔MIC (SUB) 插孔只有
在另外有一隻麥克風插 MIC (MAIN) 插孔的情況下才能使用。
調整 MIC VOL +/
麥克風打開時有回饋雜
音。
麥克風正對著揚聲器。 移開麥克風不直對著揚聲器。
麥克風音量調太高。向下轉動麥克風音量控制鈕。
顯示幕上會顯示
TRAYLOCK,同時無法
退出碟盤。
按住前面板上的 OPEN/CLOSE 按鍵不放約八秒鐘。
接著便可使用 OPEN/CLOSE 按鍵來開啟或關閉碟盤
播放
Dolby/DTS 軟體時
2D DTS 不亮起。
*
僅適用於
HTZ-FS30DVD/
HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
Dolby Digital Out(杜比數碼輸出設定為 PCM揚聲器音頻輸出轉換
PCM 確定本機設定為 Dolby Digital (杜比數碼)或 DTS (請參閱第
38 頁的
數位音頻輸出設置
)。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 56 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
57
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
DVD/CD/VCD 播放器
問題 解決辦法
碟片在置入後又自動退
出。
清潔碟片並將碟片正確對準碟片導槽。
如果 DVD-video 碟片上的地區代碼與本機上的代碼不相符,該碟片便不能
使用 (請參閱第
54 頁的 DVD Video
適用地區
。在此情況下,螢幕上會出
現下列訊息:
Incompatible disc region number/Can’t play disc (非兼容碟片
區域碼/無法播放碟片)
讓播放器內部的水氣有時間蒸發。避免在空調設備附近使用本機。
無法進行播放。
如果碟片在置入時放反,請重新將碟片標籤面朝上放入。
影像播放中止,且按鍵
無法使用。
按下 (停止)按鍵,然後按下 (播放)按鍵開始播放。
先將電源關閉然後再使用前面板上的 STANDBY/ON 按鍵將電源打
設定值全部消除。
電源發生中斷時,將會消除設定值。
沒有影像/沒有色彩。
檢查連接是否正確以及插頭是否完全插入。
查閱電視機/顯示器的操作手冊,以確定設定值是否正確。
若是選取 Progressive(逐行掃描)設定值卻已用色差視頻連接線來連接逐
行掃描信號不相容的電視機,將完全無法看到任何畫面。使用合成或
S-video 端子接上電視機後,請將 Component Out (色差視頻輸出)設定
值變更為 Interlace (隔行掃描)請參閱第
38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
)。
螢幕畫面拉長或比例沒
變。
TV Screen (電視機屏幕)的設定值不正確。 重新設置電視機螢幕的選項,
使其與您使用的電視機/顯示器相符 (請參閱第
38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
)。
當在
VCR 上或透過 AV
選取器進行錄製,便會
干擾到影像的播放。
本系統為採用防拷技術以避免透 VCR AV 選取器發生錄製或影像方面
的問題。這並不是故障。
畫面在播放期間受到干
擾或呈現一片漆黑。
本播放器與
Macro-Vision System
防拷系統相容。有些碟片內含防拷訊號,而
且此種碟片在播放時,在畫面上一些地方會出現如線條等的雜訊 (視使用的電視
機類型而定)
這並不是故障。
碟片對特別的播放器功能反應不同。這可能會導致畫面在功能執行當時,
短時間呈現漆黑或輕微晃動的現象。這些問題便因為碟片與碟片內容之間的
差異而更加突顯,但並不是本機故障所致。
DVD CD 音量有明
顯差異。
DVD CD 使用的錄製方式不同。這並不是故障。
CD-ROM 碟片無法辨
識。
確定 CD-ROM 是使用 ISO 9660 的碟片格式錄製更多關於碟片相容性的資
訊,請參閱第
51 頁的
碟片相容性參照表
無法辨識
DVD-ROM
碟片。
確定 DVD-ROM 是採用 UDF bridge 格式錄製。更多關於碟片相容性的資
訊,請參閱第
51 頁的
碟片相容性參照表
檔案無法在碟片導向/
相片瀏覽器當中顯示。
碟片上的檔案必須以正確的副檔名命名:譬如,MP3 檔案採 .mp3
WMA 檔案採用 .wmaMPEG-4 AAC 案採用 .m4aJPEG 採用 .jpg
(大寫或小寫都可以)。請參閱第 51 頁的
碟片相容性參照表
無法播放
WMA
MPEG-4 AAC 檔案
這些檔案為採用 DRM (數位版權管理)所錄製的。這並不是故障。
無法播放 WMV 檔案。 無法播放位元率超過 192 kbps 的檔案。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 57 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
58
Zhtw
調諧器
USB 連接
HDMI 連接
問題 解決辦法
收聽電台廣播時有明顯
的雜音。
連接 AM 天線(請參閱第 11 頁的
基本接線方式
並調整其方向及位置以得
到最佳的接收條件。您也可以另外接一條內部或外部
AM 天線 (請參閱第
45 頁的
連接外部天線
完全伸展開 FM 線型天線調整至最佳接收的位然後固定於牆上您也
可以另外接一組外部
FM (請參閱 45 頁的
連接外部天線
)。
關閉其他可能造成雜訊的設備或將其移走。
調諧間距不適用您所在的國家或地區請參閱第 50 頁的
頻率間距設置
的說
明以切換調諧間隔。
自動調諧功能無法接收
到某些電台。
電台訊號微弱。自動調諧功能僅能偵測到訊號發射良好的無線電台。想要
獲得更加靈敏的調諧條件,可接上一組室外天線
問題 解決辦法
本系統無法辨識
USB
大量儲存裝置。
確定已將 USB 接頭完全插入本機內。
確認記憶體格式為 FAT16 FAT32
不支援內建有 USB 集線器 USB 裝置。
檔案無法在導覽器/相
片瀏覽器中顯示。
檔案必須要有正確的副檔譬如MP3 檔案採用 .mp3WMA 檔案採用
wma
MPEG-4 AAC 檔案採用 .m4aJPEG 採用 .jpg 大寫或小寫都可
以)
確定檔案許可權未受限制 (透過密碼等)
無法播放
WMA
MPEG-4 AAC 檔案。
這些檔案為採用 DRM (數位版權管理)所錄製的。這並不是故障。
問題 解決辦法
HDMI 視頻輸出。 確定在針對使用設備的設定中,已選取本播放器作為 HDMI 輸入 (請參閱
設備的操作手冊)
確認 HDMI 連接線已正確接上且未損壞。
確認使用 HDMI 介面接上的設備已開啟且與 HDMI 相容(這些設備須 DVI
HDCP High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection)相容)
視連接的設備而定,使用 DVI 連接可能導致信號傳輸不穩。
確定本播放器上的解析度與使用 HDMI 接的設備一致請參閱第 38 頁的
視頻輸出設定值
變更解析度。
若變更解析度後畫面一片空白,則表示選取的解析度與您的顯示器不符。
請參閱第
44 頁的
重新設定
HDMI
連接
重新設回原廠預設值
在變更
HDMI Color
HDMI
色彩)
設定值
後,顯示器的色彩出現
問題 (第
39 頁)
視連接的設備而定有些 HDMI Color HDMI 色彩)設定值可能造成畫面
無法正確顯示。此時,請視狀況使用電視機的視頻輸入設定值選取
RGB。或
者可恢復先前的 HDMI Color HDMI 色彩)設定值。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 58 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
59
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
Bluetooth 連線
錯誤訊息
沒有影像或聲音。 如果問題仍然存在在將您的 HDMI 設備直接連接至顯示器時請參閱設備
或顯示器的操作手冊,或洽詢製造商以尋求協助。
HDMI 音頻輸出。
請參閱第
44
頁的
切換
HDMI
音頻設置值
,確定已選取
TV
KURO LINK 不作用。 確認是否已牢牢連接 HDMI 連接線。
確定本機的 KURO LINK 模式已設定為 LINK ON (第 48 頁)
檢查所連接設備是否支援 KURO LINK。如需詳細資訊,請參閱您的平面電
視的操作手冊。
如果同時連接 SCART 連接線和 HDMI 線,則 KURO LINK 可能無法正常
作用。
同時連接 SCART HDMI 連接線時,請將 KURO LINK 模式設定為
LINK OFF
您的電視機自動切換輸
入。
連接電視機自動切換輸入以回應本機開機播放 DVD 或顯示圖形使用者介面
畫面 (例如碟片導向)等。
如果您不要您的電視機以這種方式切換輸入,請
將本機的
KURO LINK 模式設定為 LINK OFF (第 48 頁)
問題 解決辦法
問題 解決辦法
無法連接或操作
Bluetooth 無線技術裝
置。來自
Bluetooth
線技術裝置的聲音未發
出,或聲音中斷。
檢查靠近本機的位置是否沒有任何發射 2.4 GHz 頻段電池波的物體 (微波
爐、無線
LAN 裝置 Bluetooth 無線技術設備)。如果有這類物體靠近本
機,請將本機放在遠離它的位置。或者,請停止使用發出電磁波的物體。
檢查 Bluetooth 無線裝置是否沒有離本機太遠而且 Bluetooth 無線技術裝
置與本機之間是否沒有任何障礙物。將
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置和本機放置
在彼此不超過
10 m 的距離內,而且中間不可以有任何障礙物。
檢查 Bluetooth 傳輸器與本機的 ADAPTER PORT 是否正確連接。
Bluetooth 線技術裝置無法設定為支援 Bluetooth 無線技術的通訊模式。
檢查
Bluetooth 無線技術裝置的設定。
檢查配對是否正確。配對設定已自本機或 Bluetooth 無線技術裝置中被刪
除。重設配對。
檢查設定是否正使用支援 A2DP設定和 AVRCP 設定的Bluetooth無線
術裝置。
訊息 說明
2CH ONLY
操作僅適用於雙聲道來源,因目前來源為多聲道來源而無法進行。
96K
操作因來源為 96 kHz 數位而受到禁止。
NOISY
因背景雜音太高而無法順利完成 MCACC 設定。
ERR MIC
MCACC 設定期間,因未將麥克風接上或連接不正確而發生錯誤。
ERR SP
MCACC 設定期間,因未將揚聲器接上或連接不正確而發生錯誤。
MUTING
由於音效被靜音,因此使用操作受到限制 (請按下 MUTE)。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 59 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
60
Zhtw
重新設置系統
請使用前面板控制將系統設定值重新設回原廠
預設值。
1
系統開機後,
按下 SHIFT+SETUP
2 使用 / 選取 INITIAL後按下 ENTER
3 使用 / 選取 ALL INIT然後按 ENTER
顯示 INIT OK
4INIT OK閃爍時,按下 ENTER
1
使用語言代碼清單
有些語言選項(請參閱第 39 頁的
語言設定值
能讓您從下列
語言代碼清單
136種語言當中
設定個人喜好的語言。
1 選取 Other Language (其他語言)
2 使用 / 以選取字母代碼或是數字代碼
3 使用 / 以選取字母代碼或是數字代碼。
請參閱下列
語言代碼清單
,列有完整語言種類
及代碼的清單。
NO MIC
在未插入麥克風時,按 SHIFT+KARAOKESHIFT+ECHOSHIFT+
SHIFT+ MIC VOL +/– 即會顯示。
OC ERR 1
OC ERR 2
檢查揚聲器連接線是否短路。如果持續顯示錯誤訊息,請洽詢您的先鋒授
權服務中心或您的經銷商進行維修。
OVER TEMP
嘗試降低音量。如果拔下和插入電源線無法修正此問題,表示本機可能已
損壞。在此情況中,請洽詢先鋒授權服務中心或離您最新的經銷商。
BT ERR
Bluetooth 傳輸器的消耗功率太高,以致於無法供應電源。重新連接
Bluetooth 輸器。
TV AUDIO
如果聆聽模式在設定供電視使用的 HDMI 音訊模式時變更則顯示燈會亮起
兩秒。
CANNOT
由於未選取 DVD/CD USB,所以會使操作受到限制。
在未選取 DVD/CD 和按下 SHIFT+USB REC 時顯示。
KARAOKE
插上麥克風時,在您按下 SURROUNDSOUNDAUTO/STEREOSOUND
RETRIEVER
SHIFT+MCACC
僅適用於
HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-A
)時顯示。
TRAYLOCK
碟盤鎖啟動。請參閱第 56 頁的
故障排除
一般問題
KEYLOCK
按鍵鎖啟用。請參閱第 51 頁的
設置睡眠定時器
PHONESIN
操作因耳機插上而無法進行。
HDMI ERR
請參閱上述 HDMI
連接
的故障排除提示若仍有問題則請參閱第 44 頁的
重新設定
HDMI
連接
USB ERR
如需更多與此相關的資訊,請參閱第 32 頁的
使用
USB
介面
重要提示
EEP ERR
維修事宜請洽詢您的先鋒授權服務中心或您的經銷商。
EXIT
輸入禁止的訊號或在顯示選單畫面時接上麥克風即會顯示,然後畫面會返
回正常畫面。
訊息 說明
附註
1 請勿因為系統電源自動開啟,就隨意亂使用本機或拉扯電源線。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 60 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
61
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
語言代碼清單
語言 (語言字母代碼)語言代碼
國家/地區代碼清單
國家/地區、國家/地區代碼、國家/地區字母代碼
Japanese (ja), 1001
English (en), 0514
French (fr), 0618
German (de), 0405
Italian (it), 0920
Spanish (es), 0519
Dutch (nl), 1412
Russian (ru), 1821
Chinese (zh), 2608
Korean (ko), 1115
Greek (el), 0512
Afar (aa), 0101
Abkhazian (ab), 0102
Afrikaans (af), 0106
Amharic (am), 0113
Arabic (ar), 0118
Assamese (as), 0119
Aymara (ay), 0125
Azerbaijani (az), 0126
Bashkir (ba), 0201
Byelorussian (be), 0205
Bulgarian (bg), 0207
Bihari (bh), 0208
Bislama (bi), 0209
Bengali (bn), 0214
Tibetan (bo), 0215
Breton (br), 0218
Catalan (ca), 0301
Corsican (co), 0315
Czech (cs), 0319
Welsh (cy), 0325
Danish (da), 0401
Bhutani (dz), 0426
Esperanto (eo), 0515
Estonian (et), 0520
Basque (eu), 0521
Persian (fa), 0601
Finnish (fi), 0609
Fiji (fj), 0610
Faroese (fo), 0615
Frisian (fy), 0625
Irish (ga), 0701
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704
Galician (gl), 0712
Guarani (gn), 0714
Gujarati (gu), 0721
Hausa (ha), 0801
Hindi (hi), 0809
Croatian (hr), 0818
Hungarian (hu), 0821
Armenian (hy), 0825
Interlingua (ia), 0901
Interlingue (ie), 0905
Inupiak (ik), 0911
Indonesian (in), 0914
Icelandic (is), 0919
Hebrew (iw), 0923
Yiddish (ji), 1009
Javanese (jw), 1023
Georgian (ka), 1101
Kazakh (kk), 1111
Greenlandic (kl), 1112
Cambodian (km), 1113
Kannada (kn), 1114
Kashmiri (ks), 1119
Kurdish (ku), 1121
Kirghiz (ky), 1125
Latin (la), 1201
Lingala (ln), 1214
Laothian (lo), 1215
Lithuanian (lt), 1220
Latvian (lv), 1222
Malagasy (mg), 1307
Maori (mi), 1309
Macedonian (mk), 1311
Malayalam (ml), 1312
Mongolian (mn), 1314
Moldavian (mo), 1315
Marathi (mr), 1318
Malay (ms), 1319
Maltese (mt), 1320
Burmese (my), 1325
Nauru (na), 1401
Nepali (ne), 1405
Norwegian (no), 1415
Occitan (oc), 1503
Oromo (om), 1513
Oriya (or), 1518
Panjabi (pa), 1601
Polish (pl), 1612
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619
Portuguese (pt), 1620
Quechua (qu), 1721
Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813
Kirundi (rn), 1814
Romanian (ro), 1815
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823
Sanskrit (sa), 1901
Sindhi (sd), 1904
Sangho (sg), 1907
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908
Sinhalese (si), 1909
Slovak (sk), 1911
Slovenian (sl), 1912
Samoan (sm), 1913
Shona (sn), 1914
Somali (so), 1915
Albanian (sq), 1917
Serbian (sr), 1918
Siswati (ss), 1919
Sesotho (st), 1920
Sundanese (su), 1921
Swedish (sv), 1922
Swahili (sw), 1923
Tamil (ta), 2001
Telugu (te), 2005
Tajik (tg), 2007
Thai (th), 2008
Tigrinya (ti), 2009
Turkmen (tk), 2011
Tagalog (tl), 2012
Setswana (tn), 2014
Tonga (to), 2015
Turkish (tr), 2018
Tsonga (ts), 2019
Tatar (tt), 2020
Twi (tw), 2023
Ukrainian (uk), 2111
Urdu (ur), 2118
Uzbek (uz), 2126
Vietnamese (vi), 2209
Volapük (vo), 2215
Wolof (wo), 2315
Xhosa (xh), 2408
Yoruba (yo), 2515
Zulu (zu), 2621
阿根廷
, 0118, ar
澳洲
, 0121, au
奧地利
, 0120, at
比利時
, 0205, be
巴西
, 0218, br
加拿大
, 0301, ca
智利
, 0312, cl
中國
, 0314, cn
丹麥
, 0411, dk
芬蘭
, 0609, fi
法國
, 0618, fr
德國
, 0405, de
香港
, 0811, hk
印度
, 0914, in
印尼
, 0904, id
義大利
, 0920, it
日本
, 1016, jp
韓國
, 1118, kr
馬來西亞
, 1325, my
墨西哥
, 1324, m x
荷蘭
, 1412, nl
紐西蘭
, 1426, nz
挪威
, 1415, no
巴基斯坦
, 1611, pk
菲律賓
, 1608, ph
葡萄牙
, 1620, pt
俄國 (俄羅斯聯邦)
, 1821, ru
新加坡
, 1907, sg
西班牙
, 0519, es
瑞士
, 0308, ch
瑞典
, 1905, se
台灣
, 2023, tw
泰國
, 2008, th
英國
, 0702, gb
美國
, 2119, us
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 61 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
62
Zhtw
規格
擴大器部分
RMS 功率輸出:
前置、中置、環繞聲
. . . . . . . 每個聲道 100 W
1 kHz, 10 % T.H.D., 4
重低音
. . . . . . .100 W 100 Hz, 10 % T.H.D., 4
碟片部分
類型 . . . . . . . . . . DVD 系統,VCD/ 超級 VCD
系統及碟片數位音響系統
FM 調諧器部分
頻率範圍. . . . . . . . . . . 87.5 MHz 108 MHz
天線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 ,不平衡式
AM 調諧器部分
頻率範圍:
沙烏地阿拉伯、以色列、南非或其他中東國家
與免稅機型 . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz 1602 kHz
其他機種
採用 9 kHz 間距 . . . . 531 kHz 1602 kHz
採用 10 kHz 間距 . . . 530 kHz 1700 kHz
天線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 環型天線
其他
電源需求:
新加坡、印尼、香港、馬來西亞、菲律賓機種
. . . . . . . .AC 220 V 240 V50 Hz/60 Hz
其他機種
. . . . . . . .AC 110 V 240 V50 Hz/60 Hz
消耗功率. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 W
待機消耗功率
KURO LINK ON. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.73 W
KURO LINK OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W
尺寸
....420 mm
(寬)
x 62 mm
(高)
x 331 mm
(深)
重量:
適用於
XV-DV585AP/787AP/787
. . . . .2.9 kg
適用於
XV-DV30FS/30FSAP
. . . . . . . .2.8 kg
配件 DVD/CD 接收器)
遙控器 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
AA/R6
乾電池 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
(用以確認系統操作)
視頻連接線 (黃色插頭)
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
AM
環型天線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
FM
天線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
麥克風 (用於自動 MCACC 設定)
1
. . . . . . . .1
電源線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
安裝指南
操作手冊 (本文件)
S-DV585 揚聲器系統
前置/環繞揚聲器
外箱 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 封閉式書架型 (防磁)
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統
揚聲器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 圓錐體型
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz 20 kHz
最大輸入功率. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
尺寸
...... 96 mm
(寬)
x 96 mm
(高)
x 96 mm
(深)
重量. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg
中置揚聲器
外箱. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 封閉式書架型 (防磁)
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統
揚聲器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.6 cm 圓錐體型
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz 20 kHz
最大輸入功率. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50 W
尺寸
......96 mm
(寬)
x 96 mm
(高)
x 96 mm
(深)
重量. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg
重低
外箱. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 低音反射落地型
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統
揚聲器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 圓錐體型
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz 1 kHz
最大輸入功率 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
尺寸
...... 230 mm
(寬)
x 380 mm
(高)
x 360 mm
(深)
重量. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg
配件
揚聲器連接線. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
托架. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
固定托架 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
螺絲 (用於托架和固定托架) . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
小型防滑墊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
大型防滑墊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
S-DV787T 揚聲器系統
前置/環繞揚聲器
外箱. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 封閉式落地型 (防磁)
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way 系統
揚聲器:
低音
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.7 cm 圓錐體型
高音
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm 半圓
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz 20 kHz
最大輸入功率. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
尺寸
.........260 mm
(寬)
x 1097 mm
(高)
x 260 mm
(深)
重量. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg
中置揚聲器
外箱. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 封閉式書架型 (防磁)
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統
揚聲器
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.7 cm 圓錐體型
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz 20 kHz
最大輸入功率. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100 W
附註
1 僅適用於 HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/HTZ787DVD-AP 機種。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 62 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
其他資訊
14
63
Zhtw
English
Français
Nederlands
Italiano Español
尺寸
....... 220 mm
(寬)
x 90 mm
(高)
x 100 mm
(深)
重量 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg
配件
揚聲器連接線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
大型防滑墊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
揚聲器基座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
螺絲 (用於底座). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
S-DV5SW 揚聲器系統
重低音
S-DV585 重低音相同
如上述
)。
配件
大型防滑墊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
S-DV30FS 揚聲器系統
前置揚聲器
外箱 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 封閉式落地型 (防磁)
系統
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way 系統
揚聲器:
低音
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 cm 圓錐體型 x 2
高音 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm 半圓型
阻抗
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
頻率範圍
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Hz 20 kHz
最大輸入功率 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W
尺寸:
未附帶揚聲器支架
......77 mm
(寬)
x 395 mm
(高)
x 55 mm
(深)
附帶揚聲器支架
.....150 mm
(寬)
x 414 mm
(高)
1
x 150 mm
(深)
重量:
未附帶揚聲器支架 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.0 kg
附帶揚聲器支架. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 kg
重低音
S-DV585 重低音相同
如上述
)。
2
配件
揚聲器連接線 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
揚聲器基座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
桿子 (附帶圓螺帽). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
金屬扣 (用於前側). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
金屬扣 (用於後側). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
螺絲 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
蓋子 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
六角螺帽 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
墊片 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
扳手 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
大型防滑墊 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
附註
為求產品改良規格及設計如有變更恕不
另行通知。
Dolby Laboratories
授權製造
杜比
Dolby
Pro Logic
與雙
D
標誌是
Dolby Laboratories
的商標。
適用於 HTZ585DVD-AP/HTZ787DVD/
HTZ787DVD-AP
本機係根據美國專利編號
5,451,942
5,956,674
5,974,380
5,978,762
6,487,535
和已核准與申請中之其他美國和世
界專利的授權製造。
DTS
DTS Digital
Surround
DTS, Inc.
的註冊商標,
DTS
誌和符號是
DTS, Inc.
的商標。版權所有
©1996-2008 DTS, Inc.
。保留所有權利。
適用於 HTZ-FS30DVD/HTZ-FS30DVD-AP
本機係根據美國專利編號
5,451,942
5,956,674
5,974,380
5,978,762
6,487,535
和已核准與
申請中之其他美國和世界專利的授權製造
DTS
DTS 2.0 + Digital Out
DTS, Inc.
的註冊商標,
DTS
標誌和符號是
DTS, Inc.
的商標
© 1996-2008
DTS, Inc
保留所有權利。
日本先鋒公司出版。
版權
© 2009 日本先鋒公司。
版權所有。
附註
1 調整揚聲器底座可達到的最大高度為 567 mm
2 本機的最大輸入功率 100 W
DRM(數位版權管理)是一種藉由限制
壓縮音頻檔案僅能在電腦以外錄製此
種檔案專用的裝置(或其他錄製設備)
放,專為有效預防非法拷貝而設計的
防拷技術。相關詳細資訊,請參閱個
人電腦及/或軟體所附的使用手冊或
說明檔案。
HTZ585DVD_EN.book Page 63 Thursday, April 23, 2009 2:57 PM
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
<XRE3234-A>Printed in
Published by Pioneer Corporation.
Coppyright © 2009 Pioneer Corporation.
All rights reserved.
PIONEER CORPORATION
4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411
PIONEER EUROPE NV
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico,D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270
K002_B_En
HTZ585DVD_EN.book 64 ページ 2009年3月19日 木曜日 午後6時35分
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
2


Need help? Post your question in this forum.

Forumrules


Report abuse

Libble takes abuse of its services very seriously. We're committed to dealing with such abuse according to the laws in your country of residence. When you submit a report, we'll investigate it and take the appropriate action. We'll get back to you only if we require additional details or have more information to share.

Product:

For example, Anti-Semitic content, racist content, or material that could result in a violent physical act.

For example, a credit card number, a personal identification number, or an unlisted home address. Note that email addresses and full names are not considered private information.

Forumrules

To achieve meaningful questions, we apply the following rules:

Register

Register getting emails for Pioneer HTZ-FS30DVD at:


You will receive an email to register for one or both of the options.


Get your user manual by e-mail

Enter your email address to receive the manual of Pioneer HTZ-FS30DVD in the language / languages: English as an attachment in your email.

The manual is 8,79 mb in size.

 

You will receive the manual in your email within minutes. If you have not received an email, then probably have entered the wrong email address or your mailbox is too full. In addition, it may be that your ISP may have a maximum size for emails to receive.

The manual is sent by email. Check your email

If you have not received an email with the manual within fifteen minutes, it may be that you have a entered a wrong email address or that your ISP has set a maximum size to receive email that is smaller than the size of the manual.

The email address you have provided is not correct.

Please check the email address and correct it.

Your question is posted on this page

Would you like to receive an email when new answers and questions are posted? Please enter your email address.



Info